binutils, gdb: support zstd compressed debug sections
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474 @smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493 @end smallexample
494
495 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500 This option enables warnings when
501 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504 output region.
505
506 @cindex entry point, from command line
507 @kindex -e @var{entry}
508 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509 @item -e @var{entry}
510 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519 @kindex --exclude-libs
520 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528 be treated as hidden.
529
530 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541 regardless of this option.
542
543 @cindex dynamic symbol table
544 @kindex -E
545 @kindex --export-dynamic
546 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
547 @item -E
548 @itemx --export-dynamic
549 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
550 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563 linking the program itself.
564
565 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574 @cindex export dynamic symbol
575 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
586 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591 @ifclear SingleFormat
592 @cindex big-endian objects
593 @cindex endianness
594 @kindex -EB
595 @item -EB
596 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598 @cindex little-endian objects
599 @kindex -EL
600 @item -EL
601 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602 @end ifclear
603
604 @kindex -f @var{name}
605 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606 @item -f @var{name}
607 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621 machine-specific performance.
622
623 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626 @kindex -F @var{name}
627 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
628 @item -F @var{name}
629 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
630 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641 @var{name}.
642
643 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645 object files.
646 @ifclear SingleFormat
647 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650 environment variable.
651 @end ifclear
652 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653 creating an ELF shared object.
654
655 @cindex finalization function
656 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
657 @item -fini=@var{name}
658 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661 the function to call.
662
663 @kindex -g
664 @item -g
665 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667 @kindex -G @var{value}
668 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669 @cindex object size
670 @item -G @var{value}
671 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677 @cindex runtime library name
678 @kindex -h @var{name}
679 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
680 @item -h @var{name}
681 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
682 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
687
688 @kindex -i
689 @cindex incremental link
690 @item -i
691 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693 @cindex initialization function
694 @kindex -init=@var{name}
695 @item -init=@var{name}
696 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699 function to call.
700
701 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
702 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
703 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704 @item -l @var{namespec}
705 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719 @var{filename}.
720
721 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729 archives multiple times.
730
731 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733 @ifset GENERIC
734 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736 behaviour of the AIX linker.
737 @end ifset
738
739 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
740 @kindex -L @var{dir}
741 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742 @item -L @var{searchdir}
743 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752 option is specified.
753
754 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758 @ifset UsesEnvVars
759 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762 @end ifset
763
764 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768 @cindex emulation
769 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
770 @item -m @var{emulation}
771 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778 configured.
779
780 @cindex link map
781 @kindex -M
782 @kindex --print-map
783 @item -M
784 @itemx --print-map
785 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786 information about the link, including the following:
787
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 Where object files are mapped into memory.
791 @item
792 How common symbols are allocated.
793 @item
794 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796 @item
797 The values assigned to symbols.
798
799 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805 linker script containing:
806
807 @smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811 @end smallexample
812
813 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814 option is used:
815
816 @smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820 @end smallexample
821
822 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823 scripts.
824
825 @item
826 How GNU properties are merged.
827
828 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832 @smallexample
833 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834 @end smallexample
835
836 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840 @smallexample
841 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842 @end smallexample
843
844 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847 @end itemize
848
849 @cindex link map discarded
850 @kindex --print-map-discarded
851 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852 @item --print-map-discarded
853 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855 in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857 @kindex -n
858 @cindex read-only text
859 @cindex NMAGIC
860 @kindex --nmagic
861 @item -n
862 @itemx --nmagic
863 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867 @kindex -N
868 @kindex --omagic
869 @cindex read/write from cmd line
870 @cindex OMAGIC
871 @item -N
872 @itemx --omagic
873 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878 specification published by Microsoft.
879
880 @kindex --no-omagic
881 @cindex OMAGIC
882 @item --no-omagic
883 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888 @kindex -o @var{output}
889 @kindex --output=@var{output}
890 @cindex naming the output file
891 @item -o @var{output}
892 @itemx --output=@var{output}
893 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898 @cindex dependency file
899 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912 @kindex -O @var{level}
913 @cindex generating optimized output
914 @item -O @var{level}
915 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
924 @item -plugin @var{name}
925 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929 wish.
930
931 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937 just copy in the newest one.
938
939 @kindex --push-state
940 @cindex push state governing input file handling
941 @item --push-state
942 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956 something as follows:
957
958 @smallexample
959 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @kindex --pop-state
963 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
964 @item --pop-state
965 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966 flags governing input file handling.
967
968 @kindex -q
969 @kindex --emit-relocs
970 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
971 @item -q
972 @itemx --emit-relocs
973 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976 in larger executables.
977
978 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980 @kindex --force-dynamic
981 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982 @item --force-dynamic
983 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984 to VxWorks targets.
985
986 @cindex partial link
987 @cindex relocatable output
988 @kindex -r
989 @kindex --relocatable
990 @item -r
991 @itemx --relocatable
992 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996 @code{OMAGIC}.
997 @c ; see @option{-N}.
998 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006 with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010 @kindex -R @var{file}
1011 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012 @cindex symbol-only input
1013 @item -R @var{filename}
1014 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022 the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024 @kindex -s
1025 @kindex --strip-all
1026 @cindex strip all symbols
1027 @item -s
1028 @itemx --strip-all
1029 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031 @kindex -S
1032 @kindex --strip-debug
1033 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1034 @item -S
1035 @itemx --strip-debug
1036 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038 @kindex --strip-discarded
1039 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040 @item --strip-discarded
1041 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043 Enabled by default.
1044
1045 @kindex -t
1046 @kindex --trace
1047 @cindex input files, displaying
1048 @item -t
1049 @itemx --trace
1050 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054 a linker bug report.
1055
1056 @kindex -T @var{script}
1057 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1058 @cindex script files
1059 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067 options accumulate.
1068
1069 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1070 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071 @cindex script files
1072 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083 @samp{gcc}).
1084
1085 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087 @cindex undefined symbol
1088 @item -u @var{symbol}
1089 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099 instead.
1100
1101 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102 @cindex symbols, require defined
1103 @cindex defined symbol
1104 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112 @kindex -Ur
1113 @cindex constructors
1114 @item -Ur
1115 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122 @samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125 @cindex orphan sections
1126 @cindex sections, orphan
1127 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133 @table @code
1134 @item place
1135 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139 @item discard
1140 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143 @item warn
1144 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145 issue a warning.
1146
1147 @item error
1148 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149 @end table
1150
1151 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161 in a linker script.
1162
1163 @kindex -v
1164 @kindex -V
1165 @kindex --version
1166 @cindex version
1167 @item -v
1168 @itemx --version
1169 @itemx -V
1170 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171 lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173 @kindex -x
1174 @kindex --discard-all
1175 @cindex deleting local symbols
1176 @item -x
1177 @itemx --discard-all
1178 Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180 @kindex -X
1181 @kindex --discard-locals
1182 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1183 @item -X
1184 @itemx --discard-locals
1185 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191 @cindex symbol tracing
1192 @item -y @var{symbol}
1193 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196 to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1202 @item -Y @var{path}
1203 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204 for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207 @item -z @var{keyword}
1208 The recognized keywords are:
1209 @table @samp
1210
1211 @item bndplt
1212 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226 @item cet-report=none
1227 @itemx cet-report=warning
1228 @itemx cet-report=error
1229 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241 @item combreloc
1242 @itemx nocombreloc
1243 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246 @item common
1247 @itemx nocommon
1248 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254 using pages of this size.
1255
1256 @item defs
1257 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269 these options.
1270
1271 @item execstack
1272 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274 @item global
1275 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279 @item globalaudit
1280 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287 @item ibtplt
1288 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291 @item ibt
1292 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296 @item indirect-extern-access
1297 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306 section.
1307
1308 @item initfirst
1309 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314 objects.
1315
1316 @item interpose
1317 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319 libraries not so marked.
1320
1321 @item unique
1322 @itemx nounique
1323 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
1331 @item lam-u48
1332 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335 @item lam-u57
1336 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339 @item lam-u48-report=none
1340 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351 @item lam-u57-report=none
1352 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363 @item lam-report=none
1364 @itemx lam-report=warning
1365 @itemx lam-report=error
1366 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
1375 @item lazy
1376 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379 Lazy binding is the default.
1380
1381 @item loadfltr
1382 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1383
1384 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1386
1387 @item muldefs
1388 Allow multiple definitions.
1389
1390 @item nocopyreloc
1391 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1393
1394 @item nodefaultlib
1395 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396 should ignore any default library search paths.
1397
1398 @item nodelete
1399 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1400
1401 @item nodlopen
1402 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1403
1404 @item nodump
1405 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1406
1407 @item noexecstack
1408 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
1410 @item noextern-protected-data
1411 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416 i386 and x86-64.
1417
1418 @item noreloc-overflow
1419 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1422
1423 @item now
1424 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1426 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428 called.
1429
1430 @item origin
1431 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1432
1433 @item pack-relative-relocs
1434 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1435 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1436 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1437 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1438 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1439 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1440 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1441 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1442 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1443
1444 @item relro
1445 @itemx norelro
1446 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1447 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1448 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1449 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1450 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1451
1452 @item report-relative-reloc
1453 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1454 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1455
1456 @item separate-code
1457 @itemx noseparate-code
1458 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1459 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1460 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1461 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1462
1463 @item shstk
1464 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1465 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1466 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1467
1468 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1469 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1470 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1471 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1472
1473 @item start-stop-gc
1474 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1475 @cindex start-stop-gc
1476 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1477 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1478 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1479 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1480 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1481 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1482 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1483 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1484 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1485 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1486 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1487 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1488 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1489
1490 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1491 @cindex visibility
1492 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1493 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1494 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1495 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1496 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1497 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1498 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1499 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1500 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1501 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1502
1503 @item text
1504 @itemx notext
1505 @itemx textoff
1506 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1507 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1508 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1509
1510 @item undefs
1511 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1512 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1513 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1514
1515 @item unique-symbol
1516 @itemx nounique-symbol
1517 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1518 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1519 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1520
1521 @item x86-64-baseline
1522 @item x86-64-v2
1523 @item x86-64-v3
1524 @itemx x86-64-v4
1525 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1526 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1527 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1528 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1529 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1530 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1531
1532 @end table
1533
1534 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1535
1536 @kindex -(
1537 @cindex groups of archives
1538 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1539 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1540 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1541 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1542
1543 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1544 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1545 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1546 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1547 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1548 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1549 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1550 resolved.
1551
1552 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1553 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1554 more archives.
1555
1556 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1557 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1558 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1559 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1560 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1561 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1562 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1563 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1564 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1565 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1566 restore the old behaviour.
1567
1568 @kindex --as-needed
1569 @kindex --no-as-needed
1570 @item --as-needed
1571 @itemx --no-as-needed
1572 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1573 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1574 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1575 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1576 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1577 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1578 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1579 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1580 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1581 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1582 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1583 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1584 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1585
1586 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1587 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1588 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1589 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1590
1591 @kindex --add-needed
1592 @kindex --no-add-needed
1593 @item --add-needed
1594 @itemx --no-add-needed
1595 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1596 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1597 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1598 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1599
1600 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1601 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1602 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1603
1604 @kindex -Bdynamic
1605 @kindex -dy
1606 @kindex -call_shared
1607 @item -Bdynamic
1608 @itemx -dy
1609 @itemx -call_shared
1610 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1611 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1612 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1613 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1614 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1615 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1616
1617 @kindex -Bgroup
1618 @item -Bgroup
1619 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1620 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1621 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1622 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1623 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1624
1625 @kindex -Bstatic
1626 @kindex -dn
1627 @kindex -non_shared
1628 @kindex -static
1629 @item -Bstatic
1630 @itemx -dn
1631 @itemx -non_shared
1632 @itemx -static
1633 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1634 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1635 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1636 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1637 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1638 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1639 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1640 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1641 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1642 libraries.
1643
1644 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1645 @item -Bsymbolic
1646 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1647 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1648 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1649 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1650 platforms which support shared libraries.
1651
1652 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1653 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1654 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1655 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1656 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1657 libraries.
1658
1659 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1660 @item -Bno-symbolic
1661 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1662 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1663
1664 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1665 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1666 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1667 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1668 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1669 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1670 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1671 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1672 which support shared libraries.
1673
1674 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1675 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1676
1677 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1678 @item --dynamic-list-data
1679 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1680
1681 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1682 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1683 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1684 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1685
1686 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1687 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1688 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1689
1690 @kindex --check-sections
1691 @kindex --no-check-sections
1692 @item --check-sections
1693 @itemx --no-check-sections
1694 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1695 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1696 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1697 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1698 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1699 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1700 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1701 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1702 option.
1703
1704 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1705 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1706 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1707 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1708 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1709 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1710 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1711 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1712 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1713 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1714 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1715 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1716
1717 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1718 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1719 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1720 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1721 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1722 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1723 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1724 symbols.
1725
1726 @cindex cross reference table
1727 @kindex --cref
1728 @item --cref
1729 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1730 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1731 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1732
1733 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1734 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1735 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1736 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1737 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1738 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1739 symbol are listed.
1740
1741 @cindex ctf variables
1742 @kindex --ctf-variables
1743 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1744 @item --ctf-variables
1745 @item --no-ctf-variables
1746 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1747 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1748 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1749 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1750 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1751 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1752 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1753
1754 @cindex ctf type sharing
1755 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1756 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1757 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1758
1759 @table @samp
1760 @item share-unconflicted
1761 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1762 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1763 translation unit. This is the default.
1764
1765 @item share-duplicated
1766 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1767 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1768 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1769 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1770 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1771 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1772 consumer at runtime.
1773 @end table
1774
1775 @cindex common allocation
1776 @kindex --no-define-common
1777 @item --no-define-common
1778 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1779 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1780 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
1782 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1783 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1784 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1785 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1786 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1787 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1788 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1789 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1790 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1791 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1792
1793 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1794 @cindex section groups
1795 @cindex COMDAT
1796 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1797 @item --force-group-allocation
1798 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1799 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1800 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1801 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1802 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1803 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1804
1805 @cindex symbols, from command line
1806 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1807 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1808 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1809 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1810 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1811 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1812 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1813 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1814 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1815 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1816 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1817 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1818
1819 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1820 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1821 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1822 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1823 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1824 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1825 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1826 you are trying to achieve.
1827
1828 @cindex demangling, from command line
1829 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1830 @kindex --no-demangle
1831 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1832 @itemx --no-demangle
1833 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1834 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1835 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1836 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1837 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1838 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1839 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1840 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1841 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1842
1843 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1844 @kindex -I@var{file}
1845 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1846 @item -I@var{file}
1847 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1848 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1849 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1850 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1851 doing.
1852
1853 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1854 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1855 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1856 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1857 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1858 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1859
1860 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1861 @item --embedded-relocs
1862 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1863 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1864 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1865 targets.
1866
1867 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1868 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1869 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1870 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1871
1872 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1873 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1874 @item --fatal-warnings
1875 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1876 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1877 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1878
1879 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1880 @item --force-exe-suffix
1881 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1882
1883 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1884 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1885 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1886 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1887 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1888 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1889
1890 @kindex --gc-sections
1891 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1892 @cindex garbage collection
1893 @item --gc-sections
1894 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1895 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1896 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1897 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1898 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1899 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1900 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1901
1902 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1903 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1904 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1905 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1906 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1907 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1908 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1909 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1910 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1911 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1912
1913 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1914 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1915 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1916 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1917 command in the linker script.
1918
1919 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1920 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1921
1922 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1923 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1924 @cindex garbage collection
1925 @item --print-gc-sections
1926 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1927 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1928 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1929 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1930 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1931 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1932 line.
1933
1934 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1935 @cindex garbage collection
1936 @item --gc-keep-exported
1937 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1938 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1939 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1940 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1941 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1942 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1943 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1944 ELF format targets.
1945
1946 @kindex --print-output-format
1947 @cindex output format
1948 @item --print-output-format
1949 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1950 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1951 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1952
1953 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1954 @cindex memory usage
1955 @item --print-memory-usage
1956 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1957 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1958 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1959 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1960 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1961
1962 @smallexample
1963 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1964 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1965 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1966 @end smallexample
1967
1968 @cindex help
1969 @cindex usage
1970 @kindex --help
1971 @item --help
1972 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1973
1974 @kindex --target-help
1975 @item --target-help
1976 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1977
1978 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1979 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1980 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1981 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1982 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1983
1984 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1985 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1986 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1987 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1988 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1989 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1990 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1991
1992 @smallexample
1993 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1994 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1995 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1996 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1997 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1998 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2001 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2003 @end smallexample
2004
2005 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2006
2007 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2008 operation.
2009
2010 @cindex memory usage
2011 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2012 @item --no-keep-memory
2013 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2014 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2015 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2016 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2017 while linking a large executable.
2018
2019 @kindex --no-undefined
2020 @kindex -z defs
2021 @kindex -z undefs
2022 @item --no-undefined
2023 @itemx -z defs
2024 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2025 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2026 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2027 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2028 libraries being linked in.
2029
2030 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2031
2032 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2033 @kindex -z muldefs
2034 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2035 @itemx -z muldefs
2036 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2037 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2038 first definition will be used.
2039
2040 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2041 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2042 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2043 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2044 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2045 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2046 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2047 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2048 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2049
2050 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2051 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2052 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2053 a shared library.
2054
2055 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2056 libraries specified at link time are that:
2057
2058 @itemize @bullet
2059 @item
2060 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2061 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2062 resolvable at load time.
2063 @item
2064 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2065 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2066
2067 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2068 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2069 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2070 appropriate memset function.
2071 @end itemize
2072
2073 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2074 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2075 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2076 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2077 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2078 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2079 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2080 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2081 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2082 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2083 error message will be displayed.
2084
2085 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2086 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2087
2088 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2089 @item --no-undefined-version
2090 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2091 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2092 will be issued instead.
2093
2094 @kindex --default-symver
2095 @item --default-symver
2096 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2097 exported symbols.
2098
2099 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2100 @item --default-imported-symver
2101 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2102 imported symbols.
2103
2104 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2105 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2106 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2107 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2108 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2109 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2110 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2111 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2112 inappropriate.
2113
2114 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2115 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2116 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2117 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2118
2119 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2120 @item --no-whole-archive
2121 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2122 archive files.
2123
2124 @cindex output file after errors
2125 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2126 @item --noinhibit-exec
2127 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2128 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2129 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2130 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2131
2132 @kindex -nostdlib
2133 @item -nostdlib
2134 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2135 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2136 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2137
2138 @ifclear SingleFormat
2139 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2140 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2141 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2142 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2143 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2144 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2145 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2146 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2147 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2148 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2149 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2150 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2151 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2152 @end ifclear
2153
2154 @kindex --out-implib
2155 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2156 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2157 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2158 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2159 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2160 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2161 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2162 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2163
2164 @kindex -pie
2165 @kindex --pic-executable
2166 @item -pie
2167 @itemx --pic-executable
2168 @cindex position independent executables
2169 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2170 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2171 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2172 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2173 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2174 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2175
2176 @kindex -no-pie
2177 @item -no-pie
2178 @cindex position dependent executables
2179 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2180
2181 @kindex -qmagic
2182 @item -qmagic
2183 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2184
2185 @kindex -Qy
2186 @item -Qy
2187 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2188
2189 @kindex --relax
2190 @cindex synthesizing linker
2191 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2192 @cindex --no-relax
2193 @item --relax
2194 @itemx --no-relax
2195 An option with machine dependent effects.
2196 @ifset GENERIC
2197 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2198 @end ifset
2199 @ifset H8300
2200 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2201 @end ifset
2202 @ifset XTENSA
2203 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2204 @end ifset
2205 @ifset M68HC11
2206 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2207 @end ifset
2208 @ifset NIOSII
2209 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2210 @end ifset
2211 @ifset POWERPC
2212 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2213 @end ifset
2214
2215 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2216 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2217 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2218 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2219 instructions, and combining constant values.
2220
2221 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2222 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2223 @ifset GENERIC
2224 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2225 family of processors.
2226 @end ifset
2227
2228 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2229 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2230
2231 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2232 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2233
2234 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2235 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2236 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2237 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2238 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2239 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2240 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2241 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2242 @ifset GENERIC
2243 (such as VxWorks)
2244 @end ifset
2245 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2246 run-time memory.
2247
2248 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2249 or symbols needed for relocations.
2250
2251 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2252 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2253
2254 @ifset GENERIC
2255 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2256 @cindex runtime library search path
2257 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2258 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2259 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2260 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2261 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2262
2263 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2264 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2265 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2266 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2267 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2268
2269 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2270 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2271 is defined.
2272
2273 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2274 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2275 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2276 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2277 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2278 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2279 file systems.
2280
2281 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2282 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2283 the @option{-rpath} option.
2284 @end ifset
2285
2286 @ifset GENERIC
2287 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2288 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2289 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2290 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2291 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2292 of the input files.
2293
2294 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2295 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2296 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2297 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2298 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2299 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2300 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2301 appearing multiple times.
2302
2303 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2304 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2305 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2306 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2307 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2308
2309 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2310 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2311 supported.
2312
2313 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2314 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2315 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2316 runtime linker would do.
2317
2318 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2319 libraries:
2320
2321 @enumerate
2322 @item
2323 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2324 @item
2325 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2326 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2327 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2328 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2329 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2330 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2331 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2332 @item
2333 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2334 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2335 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2336 @item
2337 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2338 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2339 @item
2340 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2341 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2342 @item
2343 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2344 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2345 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2346 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2347 @item
2348 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2349 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2350 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2351 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2352 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2353 @item
2354 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2355 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2356 header file.
2357 @item
2358 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2359 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2360 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2361 @item
2362 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2363 @item
2364 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2365 @item
2366 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2367 linker script.
2368 @end enumerate
2369
2370 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2371 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2372 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2373 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2374 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2375 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2376 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2377 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2378 of the first.
2379
2380 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2381 warning and continue with the link.
2382
2383 @end ifset
2384
2385 @kindex -shared
2386 @kindex -Bshareable
2387 @item -shared
2388 @itemx -Bshareable
2389 @cindex shared libraries
2390 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2391 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2392 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2393 undefined symbols in the link.
2394
2395 @kindex --sort-common
2396 @item --sort-common
2397 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2398 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2399 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2400 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2401 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2402 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2403 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2404 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2405
2406 @kindex --sort-section=name
2407 @item --sort-section=name
2408 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2409 patterns in the linker script.
2410
2411 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2412 @item --sort-section=alignment
2413 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2414 patterns in the linker script.
2415
2416 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2417 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2418 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2419 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2420 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2421
2422 @kindex --split-by-file
2423 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2424 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2425 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2426 size of 1 if not given.
2427
2428 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2429 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2430 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2431 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2432 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2433 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2434 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2435 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2436 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2437 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2438 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2439 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2440
2441 @kindex --stats
2442 @item --stats
2443 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2444 as execution time and memory usage.
2445
2446 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2447 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2448 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2449 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2450 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2451
2452 @kindex --task-link
2453 @item --task-link
2454 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2455 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2456
2457 @kindex --traditional-format
2458 @cindex traditional format
2459 @item --traditional-format
2460 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2461 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2462 use the traditional format instead.
2463
2464 @cindex dbx
2465 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2466 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2467 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2468 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2469 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2470 combine duplicate entries.
2471
2472 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2473 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2474 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2475 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2476 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2477 line.
2478 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2479 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2480 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2481 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2482 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2483
2484 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2485 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2486 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2487 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2488 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2489 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2490 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2491 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2492 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2493
2494 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2495 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2496 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2497 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2498 byte of the text segment.
2499
2500 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2501 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2502 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2503 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2504 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2505 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2506
2507 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2508 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2509 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2510 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2511 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2512
2513 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2514 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2515 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2516 values for @samp{method}:
2517
2518 @table @samp
2519 @item ignore-all
2520 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2521
2522 @item report-all
2523 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2524
2525 @item ignore-in-object-files
2526 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2527 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2528
2529 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2530 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2531 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2532 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2533 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2534 command line.
2535 @end table
2536
2537 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2538 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2539
2540 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2541 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2542 can change this to a warning.
2543
2544 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2545 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2546 @item --dll-verbose
2547 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2548 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2549 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2550 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2551 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2552
2553 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2554 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2555 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2556 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2557 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2558 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2559 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2560 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2561 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2562 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2563 @xref{WIN32}.
2564
2565 @kindex --warn-common
2566 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2567 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2568 @item --warn-common
2569 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2570 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2571 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2572 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2573 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2574 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2575
2576 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2577
2578 @table @samp
2579 @item int i = 1;
2580 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2581 file.
2582
2583 @item extern int i;
2584 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2585 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2586 variable somewhere.
2587
2588 @item int i;
2589 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2590 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2591 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2592 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2593 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2594 a definition of the same variable.
2595 @end table
2596
2597 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2598 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2599 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2600 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2601 a common symbol.
2602
2603 @enumerate
2604 @item
2605 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2606 definition for the symbol.
2607 @smallexample
2608 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2609 overridden by definition
2610 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2611 @end smallexample
2612
2613 @item
2614 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2615 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2616 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2617 @smallexample
2618 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2619 overriding common
2620 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2621 @end smallexample
2622
2623 @item
2624 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2625 @smallexample
2626 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2627 of `@var{symbol}'
2628 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2629 @end smallexample
2630
2631 @item
2632 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2633 @smallexample
2634 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2635 overridden by larger common
2636 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2637 @end smallexample
2638
2639 @item
2640 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2641 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2642 encountered in a different order.
2643 @smallexample
2644 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2645 overriding smaller common
2646 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2647 @end smallexample
2648 @end enumerate
2649
2650 @kindex --warn-constructors
2651 @item --warn-constructors
2652 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2653 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2654 detect the use of global constructors.
2655
2656 @kindex --warn-execstack
2657 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2658 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2659 @item --warn-execstack
2660 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2661 On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2662 messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2663 default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2664 line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2665 @option{--warn-execstack} option.
2666
2667 On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2668 executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2669 stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2670 noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
2671 can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2672
2673 Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2674 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2675 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2676 an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2677 flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2678 section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2679 some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2680 executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2681 crafted assembler files.
2682
2683 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2684 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2685 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2686 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2687 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2688 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2689 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2690 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2691 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2692 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2693 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2694 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2695 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2696
2697 @kindex --warn-once
2698 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2699 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2700 @item --warn-once
2701 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2702 which refers to it.
2703
2704 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2705 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2706 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2707 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2708 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2709 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2710 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2711 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2712 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2713 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2714 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2715
2716 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2717 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2718 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2719
2720 @kindex --warn-section-align
2721 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2722 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2723 @item --warn-section-align
2724 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2725 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2726 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2727 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2728 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2729
2730 @kindex --warn-textrel
2731 @item --warn-textrel
2732 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2733 or shared object.
2734
2735 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2736 @item --warn-alternate-em
2737 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2738
2739 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2740 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2741 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2742 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2743 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2744
2745 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2746 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2747 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2748 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2749
2750 @kindex --whole-archive
2751 @cindex including an entire archive
2752 @item --whole-archive
2753 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2754 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2755 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2756 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2757 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2758 library. This option may be used more than once.
2759
2760 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2761 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2762 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2763 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2764 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2765
2766 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2767 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2768 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2769 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2770 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2771 @var{symbol}.
2772
2773 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2774 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2775 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2776 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2777
2778 Here is a trivial example:
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 void *
2782 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2783 @{
2784 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2785 return __real_malloc (c);
2786 @}
2787 @end smallexample
2788
2789 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2790 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2791 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2792 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2793
2794 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2795 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2796 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2797 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2798 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2799
2800 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2801 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2802 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2803 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 int
2807 f (void)
2808 @{
2809 return 123;
2810 @}
2811
2812 int
2813 g (void)
2814 @{
2815 return f();
2816 @}
2817 @end smallexample
2818
2819 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2820 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2821 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2822 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2823 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2824 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2825 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2826
2827 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2828 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2829 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2830 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2831 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2832
2833 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2834 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2835 @item --enable-new-dtags
2836 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2837 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2838 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2839 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2840 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2841 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2842 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2843 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2844
2845 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2846 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2847 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2848 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2849 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2850 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2851 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2852
2853 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2854 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2855 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2856 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2857 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2858 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2859 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2860 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2861
2862 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2863 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2864 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2865 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2866 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2867 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2868 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2869 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2870 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2871 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2872 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2873 compressed using zlib.
2874
2875 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2876 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2877 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2878 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2879 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2880 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2881
2882 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2883 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2884
2885 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2886 zstd.
2887
2888 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2889 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2890 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2891 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2892
2893 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2894 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2895 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2896 @option{--help} option.
2897
2898 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2899 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2900 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2901 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2902 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2903 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2904
2905 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2906 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2907 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2908 has been used.
2909
2910 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2911 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2912
2913 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2914 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2915 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2916 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2917 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2918
2919 @kindex --build-id
2920 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2921 @item --build-id
2922 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2923 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2924 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2925 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2926 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2927 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2928 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2929 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2930 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2931 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2932 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2933
2934 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2935 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2936 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2937 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2938 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2939 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2940
2941 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2942 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2943
2944 @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2945 @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2946 Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
2947 contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
2948 specification. For more information see:
2949 https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
2950 If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
2951 creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
2952 occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
2953 If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
2954 will be validated.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @c man end
2958
2959 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2960
2961 @c man begin OPTIONS
2962
2963 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2964 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2965 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2966 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2967 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2968 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2969 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2970 object file).
2971
2972 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2973 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2974 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2975 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2976
2977 @table @gcctabopt
2978
2979 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2980 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2981 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2982 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2983 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2984
2985 @kindex --base-file
2986 @item --base-file @var{file}
2987 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2988 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2989 @file{dlltool}.
2990 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2991
2992 @kindex --dll
2993 @item --dll
2994 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2995 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2996 file.
2997 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2998
2999 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
3000 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
3001 @item --enable-long-section-names
3002 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
3003 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
3004 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3005 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3006 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3007 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3008 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3009 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3010 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3011 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3012 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3013 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3014 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3015 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3016 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3017 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3018 image and not stripping symbols.
3019 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3020
3021 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3022 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3023 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3024 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3025 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3026 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3027 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3028 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3029 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3030 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3031 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3032 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3033 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3034 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3035 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3036 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3037 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3038 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3039
3040 @kindex --leading-underscore
3041 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3042 @item --leading-underscore
3043 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3044 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3045 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3046 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3047
3048 @cindex DLLs, creating
3049 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3050 @item --export-all-symbols
3051 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3052 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3053 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3054 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3055 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3056 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3057 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3058 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3059 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3060 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3061 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3062 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3063 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3064 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3065 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3066 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3067 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3068 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3069 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3070 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3071 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3072 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3073 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3074
3075 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3076 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3077 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3078 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3079 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3080
3081 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3082 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3083 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3084 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3085
3086 @kindex --file-alignment
3087 @item --file-alignment
3088 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3089 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3090 512.
3091 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3092
3093 @cindex heap size
3094 @kindex --heap
3095 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3096 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3097 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3098 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3099 committed.
3100 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3101
3102 @cindex image base
3103 @kindex --image-base
3104 @item --image-base @var{value}
3105 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3106 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3107 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3108 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3109 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3110 for dlls.
3111 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3112
3113 @kindex --kill-at
3114 @item --kill-at
3115 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3116 symbols before they are exported.
3117 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3118
3119 @kindex --large-address-aware
3120 @item --large-address-aware
3121 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3122 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3123 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3124 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3125 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3126 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3127
3128 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3129 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3130 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3131 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3132 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3133 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3134 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3135
3136 @kindex --major-image-version
3137 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3138 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3139 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3140
3141 @kindex --major-os-version
3142 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3143 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3144 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3145
3146 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3147 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3148 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3149 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3150
3151 @kindex --minor-image-version
3152 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3153 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3154 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3155
3156 @kindex --minor-os-version
3157 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3158 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3159 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3160
3161 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3162 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3163 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3164 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3165
3166 @cindex DEF files, creating
3167 @cindex DLLs, creating
3168 @kindex --output-def
3169 @item --output-def @var{file}
3170 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3171 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3172 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3173 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3174 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3175 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3176
3177 @cindex DLLs, creating
3178 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3179 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3180 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3181 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3182 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3183 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3184 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3185 execution are avoided.
3186 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3187
3188 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3189 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3190 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3191 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3192 default.
3193 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3194
3195 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3196 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3197 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3198 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3199 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3200 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3201 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3202 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3203 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3204 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3205
3206 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3207 @item --enable-auto-import
3208 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3209 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3210 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3211 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3212
3213 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3214 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3215
3216 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3217 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3218 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3219
3220 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3221 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3222 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3223 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3224 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3225
3226 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3227 see this message:
3228
3229 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3230 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3231
3232 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3233 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3234 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3235 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3236 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3237 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3238 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3239 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3240 the warning, and exit.
3241
3242 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3243 data type of the exported variable:
3244
3245 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3246 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3247 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3248
3249 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3250 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3251 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3252 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3253
3254 @example
3255 extern type extern_array[];
3256 extern_array[1] -->
3257 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3258 @end example
3259
3260 or
3261
3262 @example
3263 extern type extern_array[];
3264 extern_array[1] -->
3265 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3266 @end example
3267
3268 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3269 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3270
3271 @example
3272 extern struct s extern_struct;
3273 extern_struct.field -->
3274 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3275 @end example
3276
3277 or
3278
3279 @example
3280 extern long long extern_ll;
3281 extern_ll -->
3282 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3283 @end example
3284
3285 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3286 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3287 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3288 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3289 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3290 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3291 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3292 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3293
3294 Original:
3295 @example
3296 --foo.h
3297 extern int arr[];
3298 --foo.c
3299 #include "foo.h"
3300 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3301 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3302 @}
3303 @end example
3304
3305 Solution 1:
3306 @example
3307 --foo.h
3308 extern int arr[];
3309 --foo.c
3310 #include "foo.h"
3311 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3312 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3313 volatile int *parr = arr;
3314 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3315 @}
3316 @end example
3317
3318 Solution 2:
3319 @example
3320 --foo.h
3321 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3322 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3323 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3324 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3325 #else
3326 #define FOO_IMPORT
3327 #endif
3328 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3329 --foo.c
3330 #include "foo.h"
3331 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3332 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3333 @}
3334 @end example
3335
3336 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3337 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3338 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3339 functions).
3340
3341 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3342 @item --disable-auto-import
3343 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3344 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3345 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3346
3347 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3348 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3349 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3350 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3351 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3352 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3353 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3354
3355 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3356 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3357 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3358 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3359
3360 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3361 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3362 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3363 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3364
3365 @kindex --section-alignment
3366 @item --section-alignment
3367 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3368 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3369 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3370
3371 @cindex stack size
3372 @kindex --stack
3373 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3374 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3375 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3376 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3377 committed.
3378 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3379
3380 @kindex --subsystem
3381 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3382 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3383 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3384 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3385 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3386 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3387 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3388 @var{which}.
3389 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3390
3391 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3392 of the PE file header:
3393 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3394
3395 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3396 @item --high-entropy-va
3397 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3398 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3399 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3400
3401 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3402 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3403
3404 @kindex --dynamicbase
3405 @item --dynamicbase
3406 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3407 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3408 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3409 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3410 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3411 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3412
3413 @kindex --forceinteg
3414 @item --forceinteg
3415 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3416 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3417 default.
3418
3419 @kindex --nxcompat
3420 @item --nxcompat
3421 @item --disable-nxcompat
3422 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3423 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3424 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3425
3426 @kindex --no-isolation
3427 @item --no-isolation
3428 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3429 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3430 This option is disabled by default.
3431
3432 @kindex --no-seh
3433 @item --no-seh
3434 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3435 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3436 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3437
3438 @kindex --no-bind
3439 @item --no-bind
3440 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3441 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3442
3443 @kindex --wdmdriver
3444 @item --wdmdriver
3445 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3446 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3447 by default.
3448
3449 @kindex --tsaware
3450 @item --tsaware
3451 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3452 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3453 default.
3454
3455 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3456 @item --insert-timestamp
3457 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3458 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3459 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3460 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3461 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3462 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3463 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3464 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3465 identically.
3466
3467 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3468 @item --enable-reloc-section
3469 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3470 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3471 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3472 This option is enabled by default.
3473 @end table
3474
3475 @c man end
3476
3477 @ifset C6X
3478 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3479
3480 @c man begin OPTIONS
3481
3482 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3483 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3484 all executables use an index of 0.
3485
3486 @table @gcctabopt
3487
3488 @kindex --dsbt-size
3489 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3490 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3491 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3492 entries.
3493
3494 @kindex --dsbt-index
3495 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3496 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3497 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3498 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3499 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3500
3501 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3502 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3503 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3504
3505 @end table
3506
3507 @c man end
3508 @end ifset
3509
3510 @ifset CSKY
3511 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3512
3513 @c man begin OPTIONS
3514
3515 @table @gcctabopt
3516
3517 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3518 @item --branch-stub
3519 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3520 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3521 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3522 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3523 the compiler or assembler.
3524
3525 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3526 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3527 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3528 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3529 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3530 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3531 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3532 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3533 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3534
3535 @end table
3536
3537 @c man end
3538 @end ifset
3539
3540 @ifset M68HC11
3541 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3542
3543 @c man begin OPTIONS
3544
3545 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3546 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3547
3548 @table @gcctabopt
3549
3550 @kindex --no-trampoline
3551 @item --no-trampoline
3552 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3553 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3554 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3555
3556 @kindex --bank-window
3557 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3558 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3559 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3560 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3561 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3562
3563 @end table
3564
3565 @c man end
3566 @end ifset
3567
3568 @ifset M68K
3569 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3570
3571 @c man begin OPTIONS
3572
3573 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3574 when linking for 68K targets.
3575
3576 @table @gcctabopt
3577
3578 @kindex --got
3579 @item --got=@var{type}
3580 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3581 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3582 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3583 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3584
3585 @end table
3586
3587 @c man end
3588 @end ifset
3589
3590 @ifset MIPS
3591 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3592
3593 @c man begin OPTIONS
3594
3595 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3596 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3597 linking for MIPS targets.
3598
3599 @table @gcctabopt
3600
3601 @kindex --insn32
3602 @item --insn32
3603 @kindex --no-insn32
3604 @itemx --no-insn32
3605 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3606 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3607 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3608 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3609 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3610 possible.
3611
3612 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3613 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3614 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3615 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3616 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3617 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3618 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3619 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3620 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3621 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3622 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3623 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3624 an error.
3625
3626 @kindex --compact-branches
3627 @item --compact-branches
3628 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3629 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3630 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3631 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3632
3633 @end table
3634
3635 @c man end
3636 @end ifset
3637
3638
3639 @ifset PDP11
3640 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3641
3642 @c man begin OPTIONS
3643
3644 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3645 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3646 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3647 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3648 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3649 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3650
3651 @table @gcctabopt
3652
3653 @kindex -N
3654 @item -N
3655 @kindex --omagic
3656 @itemx --omagic
3657
3658 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3659 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3660 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3661 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3662 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3663 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3664 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3665
3666 @kindex -n
3667 @item -n
3668 @kindex --nmagic
3669 @itemx --nmagic
3670
3671 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3672 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3673 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3674 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3675 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3676 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3677
3678 @kindex -z
3679 @item -z
3680 @kindex --imagic
3681 @itemx --imagic
3682
3683 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3684 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3685 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3686 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3687 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3688 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3689 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3690 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3691 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3692 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3693 executable} format.
3694
3695 @kindex --no-omagic
3696 @item --no-omagic
3697
3698 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3699
3700 @end table
3701
3702 @c man end
3703 @end ifset
3704
3705 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3706 @node Environment
3707 @section Environment Variables
3708
3709 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3710
3711 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3712 @ifclear SingleFormat
3713 @code{GNUTARGET},
3714 @end ifclear
3715 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3716
3717 @ifclear SingleFormat
3718 @kindex GNUTARGET
3719 @cindex default input format
3720 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3721 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3722 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3723 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3724 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3725 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3726 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3727 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3728 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3729 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3730 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3731 @end ifclear
3732
3733 @kindex LDEMULATION
3734 @cindex default emulation
3735 @cindex emulation, default
3736 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3737 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3738 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3739 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3740 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3741 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3742 linker was configured.
3743
3744 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3745 @cindex demangling, default
3746 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3747 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3748 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3749 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3750 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3751 options.
3752
3753 @c man end
3754 @end ifset
3755
3756 @node Scripts
3757 @chapter Linker Scripts
3758
3759 @cindex scripts
3760 @cindex linker scripts
3761 @cindex command files
3762 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3763 written in the linker command language.
3764
3765 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3766 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3767 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3768 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3769 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3770 described below.
3771
3772 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3773 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3774 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3775 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3776 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3777
3778 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3779 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3780 default linker script.
3781
3782 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3783 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3784 Linker Scripts}.
3785
3786 @menu
3787 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3788 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3789 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3790 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3791 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3792 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3793 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3794 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3795 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3796 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3797 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3798 @end menu
3799
3800 @node Basic Script Concepts
3801 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3802 @cindex linker script concepts
3803 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3804 describe the linker script language.
3805
3806 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3807 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3808 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3809 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3810 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3811 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3812 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3813 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3814
3815 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3816 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3817 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3818 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3819 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3820 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3821 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3822 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3823 of debugging information.
3824
3825 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3826 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3827 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3828 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3829 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3830 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3831 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3832 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3833 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3834 RAM address would be the VMA.
3835
3836 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3837 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3838
3839 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3840 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3841 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3842 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3843 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3844 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3845 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3846
3847 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3848 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3849 option.
3850
3851 @node Script Format
3852 @section Linker Script Format
3853 @cindex linker script format
3854 Linker scripts are text files.
3855
3856 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3857 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3858 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3859 generally ignored.
3860
3861 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3862 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3863 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3864 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3865 file name.
3866
3867 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3868 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3869 to whitespace.
3870
3871 @node Simple Example
3872 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3873 @cindex linker script example
3874 @cindex example of linker script
3875 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3876
3877 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3878 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3879 memory layout of the output file.
3880
3881 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3882 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3883 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3884 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3885 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3886 your input files.
3887
3888 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3889 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3890 linker script which will do that:
3891 @smallexample
3892 SECTIONS
3893 @{
3894 . = 0x10000;
3895 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3896 . = 0x8000000;
3897 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3898 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3899 @}
3900 @end smallexample
3901
3902 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3903 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3904 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3905
3906 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3907 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3908 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3909 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3910 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3911 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3912 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3913
3914 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3915 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3916 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3917 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3918 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3919 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3920
3921 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3922 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3923 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3924
3925 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3926 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3927 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3928 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3929 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3930 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3931 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3932
3933 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3934 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3935 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3936 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3937 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3938 sections.
3939
3940 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3941
3942 @node Simple Commands
3943 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3944 @cindex linker script simple commands
3945 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3946
3947 @menu
3948 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3949 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3950 @ifclear SingleFormat
3951 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3952 @end ifclear
3953
3954 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3955 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3956 @end menu
3957
3958 @node Entry Point
3959 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3960 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3961 @cindex start of execution
3962 @cindex first instruction
3963 @cindex entry point
3964 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3965 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3966 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3967 @smallexample
3968 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3969 @end smallexample
3970
3971 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3972 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3973 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3974 @itemize @bullet
3975 @item
3976 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3977 @item
3978 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3979 @item
3980 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3981 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3982 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3983 @item
3984 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3985 executable is being created - the code section is usually
3986 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
3987 @item
3988 The address @code{0}.
3989 @end itemize
3990
3991 @node File Commands
3992 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3993 @cindex linker script file commands
3994 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3995
3996 @table @code
3997 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3998 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3999 @cindex including a linker script
4000 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4001 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
4002 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
4003 10 levels deep.
4004
4005 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4006 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4007
4008 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4009 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4010 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4011 @cindex input files in linker scripts
4012 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
4013 @cindex linker script input object files
4014 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4015 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4016
4017 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4018 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4019 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4020
4021 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4022 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4023
4024 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4025 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4026 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4027 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4028 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4029 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4030 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4031
4032 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4033 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4034 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4035 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4036 path.
4037
4038 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4039 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4040 @samp{-l}.
4041
4042 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4043 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4044 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4045
4046 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4047 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4048 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4049 @cindex grouping input files
4050 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4051 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4052 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4053 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4054
4055 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4056 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4057 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4058 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4059 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4060 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4061 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4062 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4063 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4064 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4065 setting afterwards.
4066
4067 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4068 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4069 @cindex output file name in linker script
4070 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4071 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4072 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4073 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4074 precedence.
4075
4076 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4077 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4078
4079 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4080 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4081 @cindex library search path in linker script
4082 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4083 @cindex search path in linker script
4084 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4085 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4086 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4087 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4088 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4089 the command-line option are searched first.
4090
4091 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4092 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4093 @cindex first input file
4094 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4095 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4096 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4097 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4098 first file.
4099 @end table
4100
4101 @ifclear SingleFormat
4102 @node Format Commands
4103 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4104 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4105
4106 @table @code
4107 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4108 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4109 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4110 @cindex output file format in linker script
4111 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4112 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4113 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4114 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4115 line option takes precedence.
4116
4117 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4118 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4119 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4120 desired endianness.
4121
4122 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4123 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4124 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4125 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4126
4127 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4128 command:
4129 @smallexample
4130 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4131 @end smallexample
4132 This says that the default format for the output file is
4133 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4134 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4135 format.
4136
4137 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4138 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4139 @cindex input file format in linker script
4140 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4141 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4142 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4143 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4144 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4145 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4146 @end table
4147 @end ifclear
4148
4149 @node REGION_ALIAS
4150 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4151 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4152 @cindex region alias
4153 @cindex region names
4154
4155 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4156 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4157
4158 @smallexample
4159 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4160 @end smallexample
4161
4162 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4163 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4164 to memory regions. An example follows.
4165
4166 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4167 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4168 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4169 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4170 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4171 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4172 sections:
4173
4174 @itemize @bullet
4175 @item
4176 @code{.text} program code;
4177 @item
4178 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4179 @item
4180 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4181 @item
4182 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4183 @end itemize
4184
4185 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4186 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4187 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4188 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4189 @code{C}:
4190 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4191 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4192 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4193 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4194 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4195 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4196 @end multitable
4197 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4198 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4199 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4200 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4201
4202 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4203 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4204 memory layout:
4205 @smallexample
4206 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4207
4208 SECTIONS
4209 @{
4210 .text :
4211 @{
4212 *(.text)
4213 @} > REGION_TEXT
4214 .rodata :
4215 @{
4216 *(.rodata)
4217 rodata_end = .;
4218 @} > REGION_RODATA
4219 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4220 @{
4221 data_start = .;
4222 *(.data)
4223 @} > REGION_DATA
4224 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4225 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4226 .bss :
4227 @{
4228 *(.bss)
4229 @} > REGION_BSS
4230 @}
4231 @end smallexample
4232
4233 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4234 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4235 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4236 @table @code
4237 @item A
4238 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4239 @smallexample
4240 MEMORY
4241 @{
4242 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4243 @}
4244
4245 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4246 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4247 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4248 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4249 @end smallexample
4250 @item B
4251 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4252 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4253 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4254 @smallexample
4255 MEMORY
4256 @{
4257 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4258 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4259 @}
4260
4261 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4262 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4263 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4264 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4265 @end smallexample
4266 @item C
4267 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4268 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4269 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4270 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4271 @smallexample
4272 MEMORY
4273 @{
4274 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4275 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4276 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4277 @}
4278
4279 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4280 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4281 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4282 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4283 @end smallexample
4284 @end table
4285
4286 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4287 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4288 necessary:
4289 @smallexample
4290 #include <string.h>
4291
4292 extern char data_start [];
4293 extern char data_size [];
4294 extern char data_load_start [];
4295
4296 void copy_data(void)
4297 @{
4298 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4299 @{
4300 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4301 @}
4302 @}
4303 @end smallexample
4304
4305 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4306 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4307 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4308
4309 @table @code
4310 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4311 @kindex ASSERT
4312 @cindex assertion in linker script
4313 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4314 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4315
4316 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4317 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4318 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4319 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4320 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 .stack :
4324 @{
4325 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4326 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4327 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4328 @}
4329 @end smallexample
4330
4331 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4332 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4333 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4334
4335 @smallexample
4336 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4337 .stack :
4338 @{
4339 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4340 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4341 @}
4342 @end smallexample
4343
4344 will work.
4345
4346 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4347 @kindex EXTERN
4348 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4349 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4350 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4351 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4352 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4353 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4354
4355 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4356 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4357 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4358 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4359 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4360 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4361
4362 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4363 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4364 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4365 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4366 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4367 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4368
4369 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4370 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4371 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4372 @cindex section groups
4373 @cindex COMDAT
4374 This command has the same effect as the
4375 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4376 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4377 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4378 specified (@samp{-r}).
4379
4380 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4381 @kindex INSERT
4382 @cindex insert user script into default script
4383 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4384 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4385 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4386 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4387 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4388 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4389 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4390 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4391 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4392 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4393 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4394 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4395 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4396
4397 @smallexample
4398 SECTIONS
4399 @{
4400 OVERLAY :
4401 @{
4402 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4403 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4404 @}
4405 @}
4406 INSERT AFTER .text;
4407 @end smallexample
4408
4409 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4410 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4411 @cindex cross references
4412 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4413 references among certain output sections.
4414
4415 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4416 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4417 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4418 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4419 a function defined in the other section.
4420
4421 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4422 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4423 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4424 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4425 names.
4426
4427 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4428 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4429 @cindex cross references
4430 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4431 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4432
4433 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4434 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4435 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4436 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4437 must never call back.
4438
4439 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4440 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4441 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4442 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4443 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4444 names, not input section names.
4445
4446 @ifclear SingleFormat
4447 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4448 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4449 @cindex machine architecture
4450 @cindex architecture
4451 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4452 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4453 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4454 the @samp{-f} option.
4455 @end ifclear
4456
4457 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4458 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4459 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4460 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4461 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4462 @xref{Expression Section}.
4463 @end table
4464
4465 @node Assignments
4466 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4467 @cindex assignment in scripts
4468 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4469 @cindex variables, defining
4470 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4471 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4472
4473 @menu
4474 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4475 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4476 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4477 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4478 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4479 @end menu
4480
4481 @node Simple Assignments
4482 @subsection Simple Assignments
4483
4484 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4485
4486 @table @code
4487 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4488 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4489 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4490 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4491 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4492 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4493 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4494 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4495 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4496 @end table
4497
4498 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4499 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4500 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4501
4502 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4503 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4504
4505 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4506
4507 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4508
4509 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4510 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4511 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4512
4513 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4514 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4515
4516 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4517 assignments may be used:
4518
4519 @smallexample
4520 floating_point = 0;
4521 SECTIONS
4522 @{
4523 .text :
4524 @{
4525 *(.text)
4526 _etext = .;
4527 @}
4528 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4529 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4530 @}
4531 @end smallexample
4532 @noindent
4533 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4534 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4535 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4536 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4537 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4538
4539 @node HIDDEN
4540 @subsection HIDDEN
4541 @cindex HIDDEN
4542 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4543 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4544
4545 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4546 @code{HIDDEN}:
4547
4548 @smallexample
4549 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4550 SECTIONS
4551 @{
4552 .text :
4553 @{
4554 *(.text)
4555 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4556 @}
4557 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4558 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4559 @}
4560 @end smallexample
4561 @noindent
4562 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4563
4564 @node PROVIDE
4565 @subsection PROVIDE
4566 @cindex PROVIDE
4567 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4568 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4569 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4570 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4571 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4572 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4573 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4574 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4575
4576 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4577 @smallexample
4578 SECTIONS
4579 @{
4580 .text :
4581 @{
4582 *(.text)
4583 _etext = .;
4584 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4585 @}
4586 @}
4587 @end smallexample
4588
4589 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4590 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4591 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4592 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4593 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4594 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4595
4596 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4597 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4598 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4599 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4600 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4601
4602 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4603 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4604 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4605 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4606 hidden and won't be exported.
4607
4608 @node Source Code Reference
4609 @subsection Source Code Reference
4610
4611 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4612 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4613 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4614 symbol that does not have a value.
4615
4616 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4617 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4618 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4619 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4620 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4621 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4622 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4623 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4624
4625 @smallexample
4626 extern int foo;
4627 @end smallexample
4628
4629 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4630
4631 @smallexample
4632 _foo = 1000;
4633 @end smallexample
4634
4635 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4636 transformation has taken place.
4637
4638 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4639 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4640 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4641 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4642 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4643 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4644 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4645
4646 @smallexample
4647 int foo = 1000;
4648 @end smallexample
4649
4650 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4651 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4652 number 1000 is initially stored.
4653
4654 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4655 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4656 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4657 So:
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 foo = 1;
4661 @end smallexample
4662
4663 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4664 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4665 address. Whereas:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 int * a = & foo;
4669 @end smallexample
4670
4671 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4672 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4673 the variable @samp{a}.
4674
4675 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4676 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4677 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4678
4679 @smallexample
4680 foo = 1000;
4681 @end smallexample
4682
4683 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4684 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4685 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4686 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4687 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4688
4689 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4690 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4691 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4692 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4693 linker script contains these declarations:
4694
4695 @smallexample
4696 @group
4697 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4698 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4699 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4700 @end group
4701 @end smallexample
4702
4703 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4704
4705 @smallexample
4706 @group
4707 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4708
4709 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4710 @end group
4711 @end smallexample
4712
4713 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4714 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4715 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4716
4717 @smallexample
4718 @group
4719 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4720
4721 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4722 @end group
4723 @end smallexample
4724
4725 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4726 operators.
4727
4728 @node SECTIONS
4729 @section SECTIONS Command
4730 @kindex SECTIONS
4731 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4732 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4733
4734 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4735 @smallexample
4736 SECTIONS
4737 @{
4738 @var{sections-command}
4739 @var{sections-command}
4740 @dots{}
4741 @}
4742 @end smallexample
4743
4744 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4745
4746 @itemize @bullet
4747 @item
4748 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4749 @item
4750 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4751 @item
4752 an output section description
4753 @item
4754 an overlay description
4755 @end itemize
4756
4757 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4758 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4759 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4760 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4761 the layout of the output file.
4762
4763 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4764 below.
4765
4766 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4767 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4768 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4769 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4770 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4771 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4772
4773 @menu
4774 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4775 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4776 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4777 * Input Section:: Input section description
4778 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4779 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4780 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4781 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4782 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4783 @end menu
4784
4785 @node Output Section Description
4786 @subsection Output Section Description
4787 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4788 @smallexample
4789 @group
4790 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4791 [AT(@var{lma})]
4792 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4793 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4794 [@var{constraint}]
4795 @{
4796 @var{output-section-command}
4797 @var{output-section-command}
4798 @dots{}
4799 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4800 @end group
4801 @end smallexample
4802
4803 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4804
4805 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4806 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4807 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4808 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4809 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4810
4811 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4812
4813 @itemize @bullet
4814 @item
4815 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4816 @item
4817 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4818 @item
4819 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4820 @item
4821 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4822 @end itemize
4823
4824 @node Output Section Name
4825 @subsection Output Section Name
4826 @cindex name, section
4827 @cindex section name
4828 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4829 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4830 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4831 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4832 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4833 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4834 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4835 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4836 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4837 commas must be quoted.
4838
4839 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4840 Discarding}.
4841
4842 @node Output Section Address
4843 @subsection Output Section Address
4844 @cindex address, section
4845 @cindex section address
4846 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4847 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4848 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4849
4850 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4851 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4852 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4853 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4854 contained within the output section.
4855
4856 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4857
4858 @itemize @bullet
4859 @item
4860 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4861 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4862 in that region.
4863
4864 @item
4865 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4866 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4867 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4868 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4869
4870 @item
4871 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4872 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4873 counter.
4874 @end itemize
4875
4876 @noindent
4877 For example:
4878
4879 @smallexample
4880 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4881 @end smallexample
4882
4883 @noindent
4884 and
4885
4886 @smallexample
4887 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4888 @end smallexample
4889
4890 @noindent
4891 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4892 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4893 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4894 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4895 input sections.
4896
4897 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4898 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4899 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4900 do something like this:
4901 @smallexample
4902 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4903 @end smallexample
4904 @noindent
4905 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4906 aligned upward to the specified value.
4907
4908 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4909 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4910 sections are ignored).
4911
4912 @node Input Section
4913 @subsection Input Section Description
4914 @cindex input sections
4915 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4916 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4917
4918 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4919 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4920 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4921 map the input files into your memory layout.
4922
4923 @menu
4924 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4925 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4926 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4927 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4928 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4929 @end menu
4930
4931 @node Input Section Basics
4932 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4933 @cindex input section basics
4934 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4935 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4936
4937 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4938 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4939
4940 The most common input section description is to include all input
4941 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4942 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4943 @smallexample
4944 *(.text)
4945 @end smallexample
4946 @noindent
4947 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4948 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4949 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4950 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4951 example:
4952 @smallexample
4953 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4954 @end smallexample
4955 @noindent
4956 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4957 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4958 placed inside the section list, for example:
4959 @smallexample
4960 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4961 @end smallexample
4962 @noindent
4963 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4964 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4965 more than one section, as described below.
4966
4967 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4968 @smallexample
4969 *(.text .rdata)
4970 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4971 @end smallexample
4972 @noindent
4973 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4974 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4975 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4976 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4977 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4978 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4979
4980 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4981 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4982 immediately following section, for example:
4983 @smallexample
4984 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4985 @end smallexample
4986 @noindent
4987 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4988 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4989 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4990 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4991 could be modified to:
4992 @smallexample
4993 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4994 @end smallexample
4995 @noindent
4996 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4997 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4998 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4999 @smallexample
5000 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5001 @end smallexample
5002
5003 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5004 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5005 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5006 @smallexample
5007 data.o(.data)
5008 @end smallexample
5009
5010 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5011 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5012
5013 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5014
5015 @smallexample
5016 @group
5017 SECTIONS @{
5018 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5019 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5020 @}
5021 @end group
5022 @end smallexample
5023
5024 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5025 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5026 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5027 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5028 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5029
5030 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5031 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5032 with no whitespace around the colon.
5033
5034 @table @samp
5035 @item archive:file
5036 matches file within archive
5037 @item archive:
5038 matches the whole archive
5039 @item :file
5040 matches file but not one in an archive
5041 @end table
5042
5043 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5044 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5045 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5046 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5047 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5048 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5049 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5050 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5051 command.
5052
5053 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5054 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5055 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5056 @smallexample
5057 data.o
5058 @end smallexample
5059
5060 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5061 and does not contain any wild card
5062 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5063 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5064 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5065 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5066 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5067 the archive search path.
5068
5069 @node Input Section Wildcards
5070 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5071 @cindex input section wildcards
5072 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5073 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5074 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5075 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5076 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5077
5078 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5079 pattern for the file name.
5080
5081 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5082
5083 @table @samp
5084 @item *
5085 matches any number of characters
5086 @item ?
5087 matches any single character
5088 @item [@var{chars}]
5089 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5090 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5091 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5092 @item \
5093 quotes the following character
5094 @end table
5095
5096 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5097 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5098 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5099
5100 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5101 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5102 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5103 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5104 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5105 @smallexample
5106 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5107 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5108 @end smallexample
5109
5110 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5111 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5112 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5113 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5114 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5115 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5116 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5117
5118 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5119 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5120 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5121 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5122 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5123 needed.
5124
5125 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5126 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5127 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5128 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5129 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5130 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5131 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5132 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5133
5134 @cindex SORT
5135 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5136
5137 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5138 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5139
5140 @enumerate
5141 @item
5142 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5143 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5144 sections have the same name.
5145 @item
5146 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5147 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5148 sections have the same alignment.
5149 @item
5150 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5151 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5152 @item
5153 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5154 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5155 @item
5156 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5157 @end enumerate
5158
5159 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5160 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5161 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5162
5163 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5164 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5165 treated as nested sorting command.
5166
5167 @enumerate
5168 @item
5169 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5170 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5171 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5172 @item
5173 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5174 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5175 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5176 @end enumerate
5177
5178 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5179 command-line option will be ignored.
5180
5181 @cindex SORT_NONE
5182 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5183 section sorting option.
5184
5185 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5186 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5187 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5188
5189 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5190 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5191 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5192 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5193 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5194 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5195 @smallexample
5196 @group
5197 SECTIONS @{
5198 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5199 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5200 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5201 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5202 @}
5203 @end group
5204 @end smallexample
5205
5206 @node Input Section Common
5207 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5208 @cindex common symbol placement
5209 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5210 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5211 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5212 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5213 named @samp{COMMON}.
5214
5215 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5216 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5217 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5218 input files are placed in another section.
5219
5220 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5221 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5222 @smallexample
5223 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5224 @end smallexample
5225
5226 @cindex scommon section
5227 @cindex small common symbols
5228 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5229 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5230 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5231 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5232 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5233 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5234 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5235 locations.
5236
5237 @cindex [COMMON]
5238 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5239 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5240 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5241
5242 @node Input Section Keep
5243 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5244 @cindex KEEP
5245 @cindex garbage collection
5246 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5247 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5248 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5249 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5250 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5251
5252 @node Input Section Example
5253 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5254 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5255 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5256 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5257 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5258 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5259 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5260 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5261 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5262 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5263
5264 @smallexample
5265 @group
5266 SECTIONS @{
5267 outputa 0x10000 :
5268 @{
5269 all.o
5270 foo.o (.input1)
5271 @}
5272 @end group
5273 @group
5274 outputb :
5275 @{
5276 foo.o (.input2)
5277 foo1.o (.input1)
5278 @}
5279 @end group
5280 @group
5281 outputc :
5282 @{
5283 *(.input1)
5284 *(.input2)
5285 @}
5286 @}
5287 @end group
5288 @end smallexample
5289
5290 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5291 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5292 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5293 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5294 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5295 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5296 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5297
5298 @node Output Section Data
5299 @subsection Output Section Data
5300 @cindex data
5301 @cindex section data
5302 @cindex output section data
5303 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5304 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5305 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5306 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5307 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5308 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5309 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5310 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5311 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5312 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5313 counter.
5314
5315 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5316 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5317 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5318 stored.
5319
5320 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5321 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5322 @smallexample
5323 BYTE(1)
5324 LONG(addr)
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5328 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5329 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5330 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5331 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5332
5333 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5334 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5335 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5336 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5337 endianness of the first input object file.
5338
5339 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5340 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5341 @smallexample
5342 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5343 @end smallexample
5344 whereas this will work:
5345 @smallexample
5346 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5347 @end smallexample
5348
5349 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5350 @cindex holes, filling
5351 @cindex unspecified memory
5352 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5353 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5354 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5355 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5356 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5357 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5358 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5359 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5360 different parts of an output section.
5361
5362 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5363 value @samp{0x90}:
5364 @smallexample
5365 FILL(0x90909090)
5366 @end smallexample
5367
5368 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5369 section attribute, but it only affects the
5370 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5371 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5372 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5373 expression.
5374
5375 @node Output Section Keywords
5376 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5377 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5378 commands.
5379
5380 @table @code
5381 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5382 @cindex input filename symbols
5383 @cindex filename symbols
5384 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5385 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5386 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5387 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5388 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5389
5390 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5391 normally used for any other object file format.
5392
5393 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5394 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5395 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5396 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5397 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5398 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5399 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5400 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5401 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5402 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5403 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5404 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5405 ignored for other object file formats.
5406
5407 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5408 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5409 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5410 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5411 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5412 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5413 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5414 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5415 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5416 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5417 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5418 @code{exit}.
5419
5420 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5421 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5422 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5423 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5424 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5425 runtime code expects to see.
5426
5427 @smallexample
5428 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5429 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5430 *(.ctors)
5431 LONG(0)
5432 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5433 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5434 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5435 *(.dtors)
5436 LONG(0)
5437 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5438 @end smallexample
5439
5440 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5441 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5442 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5443 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5444 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5445 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5446 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5447 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5448
5449 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5450 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5451 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5452 scripts.
5453
5454 @end table
5455
5456 @node Output Section Discarding
5457 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5458 @cindex discarding sections
5459 @cindex sections, discarding
5460 @cindex removing sections
5461 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5462 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5463 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5464 @smallexample
5465 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5466 @end smallexample
5467 @noindent
5468 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5469 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5470 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5471 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5472 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5473 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5474 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5475 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5476 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5477
5478 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5479 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5480 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5481 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5482 section is discarded.
5483
5484 @cindex /DISCARD/
5485 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5486 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5487 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5488
5489 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5490 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5491 garbage collection.
5492
5493 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5494 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5495 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5496 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5497
5498 @node Output Section Attributes
5499 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5500 @cindex output section attributes
5501 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5502 like this:
5503
5504 @smallexample
5505 @group
5506 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5507 [AT(@var{lma})]
5508 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5509 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5510 [@var{constraint}]
5511 @{
5512 @var{output-section-command}
5513 @var{output-section-command}
5514 @dots{}
5515 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5516 @end group
5517 @end smallexample
5518
5519 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5520 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5521 remaining section attributes.
5522
5523 @menu
5524 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5525 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5526 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5527 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5528 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5529 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5530 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5531 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5532 @end menu
5533
5534 @node Output Section Type
5535 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5536 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5537 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5538
5539 @table @code
5540 @item NOLOAD
5541 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5542 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5543 @item READONLY
5544 The section should be marked as read-only.
5545 @item DSECT
5546 @item COPY
5547 @item INFO
5548 @item OVERLAY
5549 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5550 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5551 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5552 section when the program is run.
5553 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5554 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5555 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5556 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5557 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5558 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5559 special requirements of the section type are met.
5560 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5561 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5562 type specified by @var{type}.
5563 @end table
5564
5565 @kindex NOLOAD
5566 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5567 @cindex loading, preventing
5568 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5569 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5570 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5571 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5572 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5573 @smallexample
5574 @group
5575 SECTIONS @{
5576 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5577 @dots{}
5578 @}
5579 @end group
5580 @end smallexample
5581
5582 @node Output Section LMA
5583 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5584 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5585 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5586 @cindex load address
5587 @cindex section load address
5588 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5589 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5590 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5591 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5592 address is optional.
5593
5594 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5595 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5596 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5597 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5598 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5599
5600 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5601 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5602 load address:
5603
5604 @itemize @bullet
5605 @item
5606 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5607 the LMA address as well.
5608
5609 @item
5610 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5611
5612 @item
5613 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5614 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5615 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5616 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5617 the last section in the located region.
5618
5619 @item
5620 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5621 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5622
5623 @item
5624 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5625 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5626 @end itemize
5627
5628 @cindex ROM initialized data
5629 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5630 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5631 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5632 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5633 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5634 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5635 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5636 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5637 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5638
5639 @smallexample
5640 @group
5641 SECTIONS
5642 @{
5643 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5644 .mdata 0x2000 :
5645 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5646 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5647 .bss 0x3000 :
5648 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5649 @}
5650 @end group
5651 @end smallexample
5652
5653 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5654 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5655 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5656 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5657 script.
5658
5659 @smallexample
5660 @group
5661 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5662 char *src = &_etext;
5663 char *dst = &_data;
5664
5665 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5666 while (dst < &_edata)
5667 *dst++ = *src++;
5668
5669 /* Zero bss. */
5670 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5671 *dst = 0;
5672 @end group
5673 @end smallexample
5674
5675 @node Forced Output Alignment
5676 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5677 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5678 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5679 @cindex output section alignment
5680 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5681 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5682 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5683
5684 @node Forced Input Alignment
5685 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5686 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5687 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5688 @cindex input section alignment
5689 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5690 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5691 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5692
5693 @node Output Section Constraint
5694 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5695 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5696 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5697 @cindex constraints on output sections
5698 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5699 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5700 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5701 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5702
5703 @node Output Section Region
5704 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5705 @kindex >@var{region}
5706 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5707 @cindex memory regions and sections
5708 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5709 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5710
5711 Here is a simple example:
5712 @smallexample
5713 @group
5714 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5715 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5716 @end group
5717 @end smallexample
5718
5719 @node Output Section Phdr
5720 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5721 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5722 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5723 @cindex program headers and sections
5724 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5725 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5726 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5727 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5728 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5729 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5730
5731 Here is a simple example:
5732 @smallexample
5733 @group
5734 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5735 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5736 @end group
5737 @end smallexample
5738
5739 @node Output Section Fill
5740 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5741 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5742 @cindex section fill pattern
5743 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5744 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5745 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5746 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5747 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5748 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5749 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5750 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5751 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5752 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5753 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5754 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5755 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5756
5757 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5758 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5759
5760 Here is a simple example:
5761 @smallexample
5762 @group
5763 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5764 @end group
5765 @end smallexample
5766
5767 @node Overlay Description
5768 @subsection Overlay Description
5769 @kindex OVERLAY
5770 @cindex overlays
5771 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5772 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5773 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5774 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5775 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5776 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5777 than another.
5778
5779 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5780 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5781 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5782 command is as follows:
5783 @smallexample
5784 @group
5785 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5786 @{
5787 @var{secname1}
5788 @{
5789 @var{output-section-command}
5790 @var{output-section-command}
5791 @dots{}
5792 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5793 @var{secname2}
5794 @{
5795 @var{output-section-command}
5796 @var{output-section-command}
5797 @dots{}
5798 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5799 @dots{}
5800 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5801 @end group
5802 @end smallexample
5803
5804 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5805 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5806 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5807 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5808 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5809 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5810
5811 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5812 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5813
5814 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5815 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5816 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5817 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5818 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5819 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5820
5821 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5822 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5823 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5824 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5825 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5826
5827 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5828 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5829 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5830 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5831 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5832 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5833 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5834
5835 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5836 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5837
5838 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5839 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5840 @smallexample
5841 @group
5842 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5843 @{
5844 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5845 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5846 @}
5847 @end group
5848 @end smallexample
5849 @noindent
5850 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5851 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5852 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5853 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5854 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5855 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5856
5857 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5858 like the following.
5859
5860 @smallexample
5861 @group
5862 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5863 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5864 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5865 @end group
5866 @end smallexample
5867
5868 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5869 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5870 example could have been written identically as follows.
5871
5872 @smallexample
5873 @group
5874 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5875 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5876 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5877 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5878 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5879 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5880 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5881 @end group
5882 @end smallexample
5883
5884 @node MEMORY
5885 @section MEMORY Command
5886 @kindex MEMORY
5887 @cindex memory regions
5888 @cindex regions of memory
5889 @cindex allocating memory
5890 @cindex discontinuous memory
5891 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5892 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5893
5894 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5895 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5896 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5897 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5898 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5899 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5900 around to fit into the available regions.
5901
5902 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5903 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5904 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5905 @code{MEMORY} is:
5906 @smallexample
5907 @group
5908 MEMORY
5909 @{
5910 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5911 @dots{}
5912 @}
5913 @end group
5914 @end smallexample
5915
5916 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5917 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5918 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5919 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5920 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5921 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5922 command.
5923
5924 @cindex memory region attributes
5925 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5926 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5927 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5928 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5929 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5930 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5931 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5932
5933 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5934 @table @samp
5935 @item R
5936 Read-only section
5937 @item W
5938 Read/write section
5939 @item X
5940 Executable section
5941 @item A
5942 Allocatable section
5943 @item I
5944 Initialized section
5945 @item L
5946 Same as @samp{I}
5947 @item !
5948 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5949 @end table
5950
5951 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5952 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5953 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5954 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5955 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5956 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5957 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5958 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5959
5960 @kindex ORIGIN =
5961 @kindex o =
5962 @kindex org =
5963 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5964 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5965 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5966 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5967 @code{ORG}).
5968
5969 @kindex LENGTH =
5970 @kindex len =
5971 @kindex l =
5972 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5973 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5974 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5975 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5976
5977 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5978 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5979 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5980 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5981 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5982 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5983 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5984 region.
5985
5986 @smallexample
5987 @group
5988 MEMORY
5989 @{
5990 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5991 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5992 @}
5993 @end group
5994 @end smallexample
5995
5996 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5997 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5998 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5999 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6000 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6001 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6002 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6003 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6004 region, the linker will issue an error message.
6005
6006 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6007 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6008 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6009
6010 @smallexample
6011 @group
6012 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6013 @end group
6014 @end smallexample
6015
6016 @node PHDRS
6017 @section PHDRS Command
6018 @kindex PHDRS
6019 @cindex program headers
6020 @cindex ELF program headers
6021 @cindex program segments
6022 @cindex segments, ELF
6023 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6024 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6025 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6026 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6027
6028 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6029 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6030 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6031 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6032 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6033
6034 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6035 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6036 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6037 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6038 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6039
6040 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6041 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6042 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6043
6044 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6045 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6046
6047 @smallexample
6048 @group
6049 PHDRS
6050 @{
6051 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6052 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6053 @}
6054 @end group
6055 @end smallexample
6056
6057 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6058 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6059 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6060 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6061 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6062 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6063
6064 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6065 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6066 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6067 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6068 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6069 Section Phdr}.
6070
6071 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6072 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6073 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6074 contain the section.
6075
6076 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6077 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6078 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6079 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6080 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6081 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6082 segment at all.
6083
6084 @kindex FILEHDR
6085 @kindex PHDRS
6086 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6087 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6088 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6089 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6090 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6091 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6092 these keywords.
6093
6094 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6095 value of the keyword.
6096
6097 @table @asis
6098 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6099 Indicates an unused program header.
6100
6101 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6102 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6103 the file.
6104
6105 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6106 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6107
6108 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6109 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6110 found.
6111
6112 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6113 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6114
6115 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6116 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6117 ABI.
6118
6119 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6120 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6121
6122 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6123 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6124
6125 @item @var{expression}
6126 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6127 be used for types not defined above.
6128 @end table
6129
6130 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6131 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6132 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6133 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6134 output section attribute.
6135
6136 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6137 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6138 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6139 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6140 header.
6141
6142 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6143 headers used on a native ELF system.
6144
6145 @example
6146 @group
6147 PHDRS
6148 @{
6149 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6150 interp PT_INTERP ;
6151 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6152 data PT_LOAD ;
6153 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6154 @}
6155
6156 SECTIONS
6157 @{
6158 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6159 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6160 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6161 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6162 @dots{}
6163 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6164 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6165 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6166 @dots{}
6167 @}
6168 @end group
6169 @end example
6170
6171 @node VERSION
6172 @section VERSION Command
6173 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6174 @cindex symbol versions
6175 @cindex version script
6176 @cindex versions of symbols
6177 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6178 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6179 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6180 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6181 shared library.
6182
6183 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6184 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6185 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6186
6187 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6188 @smallexample
6189 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6190 @end smallexample
6191
6192 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6193 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6194 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6195 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6196 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6197 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6198 library.
6199
6200 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6201 examples.
6202
6203 @smallexample
6204 VERS_1.1 @{
6205 global:
6206 foo1;
6207 local:
6208 old*;
6209 original*;
6210 new*;
6211 @};
6212
6213 VERS_1.2 @{
6214 foo2;
6215 @} VERS_1.1;
6216
6217 VERS_2.0 @{
6218 bar1; bar2;
6219 extern "C++" @{
6220 ns::*;
6221 "f(int, double)";
6222 @};
6223 @} VERS_1.2;
6224 @end smallexample
6225
6226 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6227 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6228 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6229 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6230 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6231 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6232 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6233 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6234 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6235 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6236
6237 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6238 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6239 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6240
6241 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6242 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6243 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6244
6245 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6246 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6247 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6248 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6249 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6250 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6251 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6252 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6253 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6254
6255 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6256 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6257 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6258 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6259
6260 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6261 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6262 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6263 won't.
6264
6265 @smallexample
6266 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6267 @end smallexample
6268
6269 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6270 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6271 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6272 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6273 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6274 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6275 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6276 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6277 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6278 search for each symbol reference.
6279
6280 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6281 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6282 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6283 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6284 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6285 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6286 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6287 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6288 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6289
6290 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6291 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6292 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6293 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6294 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6295 @smallexample
6296 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6297 @end smallexample
6298 @noindent
6299 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6300 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6301 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6302 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6303 takes precedence over a version script.
6304
6305 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6306 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6307 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6308 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6309 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6310
6311 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6312 source file. Here is an example:
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6316 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6317 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6318 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6319 @end smallexample
6320
6321 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6322 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6323 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6324 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6325
6326 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6327 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6328 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6329 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6330 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6331 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6332
6333 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6334 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6335 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6336 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6337
6338 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6339
6340 @smallexample
6341 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6342 @end smallexample
6343
6344 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6345 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6346 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6347 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6348 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6349
6350 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6351 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6352 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6353 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6354 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6355 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6356 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6357 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6358 expect when you upgrade.
6359
6360 @node Expressions
6361 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6362 @cindex expressions
6363 @cindex arithmetic
6364 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6365 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6366 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6367 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6368 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6369 otherwise 64 bits.
6370
6371 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6372
6373 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6374 expressions.
6375
6376 @menu
6377 * Constants:: Constants
6378 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6379 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6380 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6381 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6382 * Operators:: Operators
6383 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6384 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6385 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6386 @end menu
6387
6388 @node Constants
6389 @subsection Constants
6390 @cindex integer notation
6391 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6392 All constants are integers.
6393
6394 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6395 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6396 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6397 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6398 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6399 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6400
6401 @cindex scaled integers
6402 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6403 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6404 @cindex suffixes for integers
6405 @cindex integer suffixes
6406 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6407 constant by
6408 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6409 @ifnottex
6410 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6411 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6412 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6413 @end ifnottex
6414 @tex
6415 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6416 @end tex
6417 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6418 respectively. For example, the following
6419 all refer to the same quantity:
6420
6421 @smallexample
6422 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6423 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6424 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6425 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6426 @end smallexample
6427
6428 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6429 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6430
6431 @node Symbolic Constants
6432 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6433 @cindex symbolic constants
6434 @kindex CONSTANT
6435 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6436 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6437
6438 @table @code
6439 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6440 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6441 The target's maximum page size.
6442
6443 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6444 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6445 The target's default page size.
6446 @end table
6447
6448 So for example:
6449
6450 @smallexample
6451 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6452 @end smallexample
6453
6454 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6455 supported by the target.
6456
6457 @node Symbols
6458 @subsection Symbol Names
6459 @cindex symbol names
6460 @cindex names
6461 @cindex quoted symbol names
6462 @kindex "
6463 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6464 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6465 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6466 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6467 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6468 @smallexample
6469 "SECTION" = 9;
6470 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6471 @end smallexample
6472
6473 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6474 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6475 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6476
6477 @node Orphan Sections
6478 @subsection Orphan Sections
6479 @cindex orphan
6480 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6481 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6482 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6483 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6484 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6485
6486 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6487 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6488 placed at the end of that output section.
6489
6490 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6491 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6492 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6493 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6494 one new output section.
6495
6496 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6497 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6498 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6499 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6500 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6501 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6502 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6503
6504 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6505 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6506 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6507
6508 @node Location Counter
6509 @subsection The Location Counter
6510 @kindex .
6511 @cindex dot
6512 @cindex location counter
6513 @cindex current output location
6514 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6515 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6516 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6517 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6518 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6519
6520 @cindex holes
6521 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6522 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6523 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6524 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6525 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6526
6527 @smallexample
6528 SECTIONS
6529 @{
6530 output :
6531 @{
6532 file1(.text)
6533 . = . + 1000;
6534 file2(.text)
6535 . += 1000;
6536 file3(.text)
6537 @} = 0x12345678;
6538 @}
6539 @end smallexample
6540 @noindent
6541 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6542 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6543 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6544 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6545 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6546 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6547
6548 @cindex dot inside sections
6549 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6550 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6551 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6552 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6553 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6554 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6555
6556 @smallexample
6557 SECTIONS
6558 @{
6559 . = 0x100
6560 .text: @{
6561 *(.text)
6562 . = 0x200
6563 @}
6564 . = 0x500
6565 .data: @{
6566 *(.data)
6567 . += 0x600
6568 @}
6569 @}
6570 @end smallexample
6571
6572 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6573 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6574 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6575 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6576 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6577 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6578 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6579 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6580
6581 @cindex dot outside sections
6582 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6583 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6584 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6585
6586 @smallexample
6587 SECTIONS
6588 @{
6589 start_of_text = . ;
6590 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6591 end_of_text = . ;
6592
6593 start_of_data = . ;
6594 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6595 end_of_data = . ;
6596 @}
6597 @end smallexample
6598
6599 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6600 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6601 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6602 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6603 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6604 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6605 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6606 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6607 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6608 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6609 as follows:
6610
6611 @smallexample
6612 SECTIONS
6613 @{
6614 start_of_text = . ;
6615 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6616 end_of_text = . ;
6617
6618 start_of_data = . ;
6619 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6620 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6621 end_of_data = . ;
6622 @}
6623 @end smallexample
6624
6625 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6626 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6627 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6628 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6629 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6630 section. So you could write:
6631
6632 @smallexample
6633 SECTIONS
6634 @{
6635 start_of_text = . ;
6636 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6637 end_of_text = . ;
6638
6639 . = . ;
6640 start_of_data = . ;
6641 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6642 end_of_data = . ;
6643 @}
6644 @end smallexample
6645
6646 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6647 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6648
6649 @need 2000
6650 @node Operators
6651 @subsection Operators
6652 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6653 @cindex arithmetic operators
6654 @cindex precedence in expressions
6655 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6656 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6657 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6658 @ifnottex
6659 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6660 @smallexample
6661 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6662 (highest)
6663 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6664 2 left * / %
6665 3 left + -
6666 4 left >> <<
6667 5 left == != > < <= >=
6668 6 left &
6669 7 left |
6670 8 left &&
6671 9 left ||
6672 10 right ? :
6673 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6674 (lowest)
6675 @end smallexample
6676 Notes:
6677 (1) Prefix operators
6678 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6679 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6680 @end ifnottex
6681 @tex
6682 \vskip \baselineskip
6683 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6684 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6685 \hrule
6686 \halign
6687 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6688 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6689 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6690 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6691 \noalign{\hrule}
6692 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6693 &highest&&&&&\cr
6694 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6695 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6696 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6697 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6698 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6699 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6700 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6701 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6702 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6703 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6704 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6705 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6706 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6707 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6708 \hrule}
6709 @end tex
6710 @iftex
6711 {
6712 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6713 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6714 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6715 }
6716 @end iftex
6717 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6718
6719 @node Evaluation
6720 @subsection Evaluation
6721 @cindex lazy evaluation
6722 @cindex expression evaluation order
6723 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6724 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6725
6726 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6727 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6728 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6729 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6730
6731 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6732 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6733 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6734 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6735
6736 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6737 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6738 allocation.
6739
6740 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6741 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6742
6743 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6744 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6745 following
6746 @smallexample
6747 @group
6748 SECTIONS
6749 @{
6750 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6751 @{ *(.text) @}
6752 @}
6753 @end group
6754 @end smallexample
6755 @noindent
6756 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6757 address}.
6758
6759 @node Expression Section
6760 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6761 @cindex expression sections
6762 @cindex absolute expressions
6763 @cindex relative expressions
6764 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6765 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6766 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6767 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6768 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6769 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6770 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6771 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6772 operations.
6773
6774 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6775 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6776 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6777 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6778 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6779 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6780 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6781 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6782 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6783 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6784 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6785 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6786 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6787 everywhere.
6788
6789 In the following simple example,
6790
6791 @smallexample
6792 @group
6793 SECTIONS
6794 @{
6795 . = 0x100;
6796 __executable_start = 0x100;
6797 .data :
6798 @{
6799 . = 0x10;
6800 __data_start = 0x10;
6801 *(.data)
6802 @}
6803 @dots{}
6804 @}
6805 @end group
6806 @end smallexample
6807
6808 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6809 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6810 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6811 section in the second two assignments.
6812
6813 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6814 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6815
6816 @itemize @bullet
6817 @item
6818 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6819 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6820 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6821 @item
6822 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6823 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6824 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6825 @item
6826 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6827 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6828 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6829 before applying the operator.
6830 @end itemize
6831
6832 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6833
6834 @itemize @bullet
6835 @item
6836 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6837 @item
6838 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6839 @item
6840 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6841 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6842 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6843 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6844 but an absolute address otherwise.
6845 @item
6846 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6847 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6848 section as the relative operand(s).
6849 @item
6850 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6851 conversions) is an absolute address.
6852 @end itemize
6853
6854 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6855 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6856 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6857 section @samp{.data}:
6858 @smallexample
6859 SECTIONS
6860 @{
6861 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6862 @}
6863 @end smallexample
6864 @noindent
6865 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6866 @samp{.data} section.
6867
6868 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6869 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6870
6871 @node Builtin Functions
6872 @subsection Builtin Functions
6873 @cindex functions in expressions
6874 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6875 use in linker script expressions.
6876
6877 @table @code
6878 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6879 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6880 @cindex expression, absolute
6881 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6882 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6883 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6884 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6885
6886 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6887 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6888 @cindex section address in expression
6889 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6890 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6891 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6892 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6893 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6894 the other two will be absolute:
6895 @smallexample
6896 @group
6897 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6898 .output1 :
6899 @{
6900 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6901 @dots{}
6902 @}
6903 .output :
6904 @{
6905 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6906 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6907 @}
6908 @dots{} @}
6909 @end group
6910 @end smallexample
6911
6912 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6913 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6914 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6915 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6916 @cindex round up location counter
6917 @cindex align location counter
6918 @cindex round up expression
6919 @cindex align expression
6920 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6921 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6922 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6923 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6924 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6925 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6926
6927 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6928 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6929 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6930 input sections:
6931 @smallexample
6932 @group
6933 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6934 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6935 *(.data)
6936 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6937 @}
6938 @dots{} @}
6939 @end group
6940 @end smallexample
6941 @noindent
6942 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6943 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6944 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6945 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6946
6947 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6948
6949 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6950 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6951 @cindex section alignment
6952 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6953 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6954 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6955 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6956 value in that section.
6957 @smallexample
6958 @group
6959 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6960 .output @{
6961 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6962 @dots{}
6963 @}
6964 @dots{} @}
6965 @end group
6966 @end smallexample
6967
6968 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6969 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6970 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6971 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6972 section.
6973
6974 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6975 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6976 This is equivalent to either
6977 @smallexample
6978 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6979 @end smallexample
6980 or
6981 @smallexample
6982 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6983 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6984 @end smallexample
6985 @noindent
6986 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6987 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6988 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6989 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6990 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6991 bytes in the on-disk file.
6992
6993 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6994 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6995 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6996 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6997 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6998 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6999 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
7000
7001 @noindent
7002 Example:
7003 @smallexample
7004 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7005 @end smallexample
7006
7007 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7008 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7009 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7010 evaluation purposes.
7011
7012 @smallexample
7013 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7014 @end smallexample
7015
7016 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7017 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7018 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7019 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7020 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7021 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7022 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7023 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7024 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7025 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7026 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7027 section alignment.
7028
7029 @smallexample
7030 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7031 @end smallexample
7032
7033 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7034 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7035 @cindex symbol defaults
7036 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7037 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7038 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7039 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7040 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7041 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7042 existed, its value is preserved:
7043
7044 @smallexample
7045 @group
7046 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7047 .text : @{
7048 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7049 @dots{}
7050 @}
7051 @dots{}
7052 @}
7053 @end group
7054 @end smallexample
7055
7056 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7057 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7058 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7059
7060 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7061 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7062 @cindex section load address in expression
7063 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7064 Section LMA}).
7065
7066 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7067 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7068 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7069 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7070
7071 @kindex MAX
7072 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7073 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7074
7075 @kindex MIN
7076 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7077 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7078
7079 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7080 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7081 @cindex unallocated address, next
7082 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7083 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7084 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7085 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7086
7087 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7088 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7089 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7090
7091 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7092 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7093 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7094 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7095 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7096 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7097 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7098 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7099 name.
7100
7101 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7102 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7103 @cindex section size
7104 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7105 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7106 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7107 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7108 @smallexample
7109 @group
7110 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7111 .output @{
7112 .start = . ;
7113 @dots{}
7114 .end = . ;
7115 @}
7116 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7117 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7118 @dots{} @}
7119 @end group
7120 @end smallexample
7121
7122 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7123 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7124 @cindex header size
7125 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7126 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7127 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7128 choose, to facilitate paging.
7129
7130 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7131 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7132 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7133 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7134 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7135 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7136 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7137 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7138 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7139 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7140 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7141 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7142 @end table
7143
7144 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7145 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7146 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7147 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7148 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7149 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7150 linker will report an error.
7151
7152 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7153
7154 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7155 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7156 commands.
7157
7158 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7159 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7160 read. This can affect archive searching.
7161
7162 @node Plugins
7163 @chapter Linker Plugins
7164
7165 @cindex plugins
7166 @cindex linker plugins
7167 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7168 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7169 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7170
7171 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7172 be added here later.
7173
7174 @menu
7175 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7176 @end menu
7177
7178 @node libdep Plugin
7179 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7180 @cindex static library dependencies
7181 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7182 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7183 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7184 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7185 rose to ascendance.
7186
7187 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7188 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7189 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7190 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7191 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7192 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7193 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7194 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7195
7196 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7197 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7198 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7199 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7200 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7201 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7202 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7203 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7204 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7205
7206 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7207 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7208 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7209
7210 @smallexample
7211 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7212 @end smallexample
7213
7214 @ifset GENERIC
7215 @node Machine Dependent
7216 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7217
7218 @cindex machine dependencies
7219 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7220 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7221 functionality are not listed.
7222
7223 @menu
7224 @ifset H8300
7225 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7226 @end ifset
7227 @ifset M68HC11
7228 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7229 @end ifset
7230 @ifset ARM
7231 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7232 @end ifset
7233 @ifset HPPA
7234 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7235 @end ifset
7236 @ifset M68K
7237 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7238 @end ifset
7239 @ifset MIPS
7240 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7241 @end ifset
7242 @ifset MMIX
7243 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7244 @end ifset
7245 @ifset MSP430
7246 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7247 @end ifset
7248 @ifset NDS32
7249 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7250 @end ifset
7251 @ifset NIOSII
7252 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7253 @end ifset
7254 @ifset POWERPC
7255 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7256 @end ifset
7257 @ifset POWERPC64
7258 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7259 @end ifset
7260 @ifset S/390
7261 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7262 @end ifset
7263 @ifset SPU
7264 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7265 @end ifset
7266 @ifset TICOFF
7267 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7268 @end ifset
7269 @ifset WIN32
7270 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7271 @end ifset
7272 @ifset XTENSA
7273 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7274 @end ifset
7275 @end menu
7276 @end ifset
7277
7278 @ifset H8300
7279 @ifclear GENERIC
7280 @raisesections
7281 @end ifclear
7282
7283 @node H8/300
7284 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7285
7286 @cindex H8/300 support
7287 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7288 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7289
7290 @table @emph
7291 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7292 @item relaxing address modes
7293 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7294 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7295 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7296 respectively.
7297
7298 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7299 @item synthesizing instructions
7300 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7301 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7302 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7303 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7304 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7305 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7306 top page of memory).
7307
7308 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7309 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7310 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7311 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7312 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7313 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7314 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7315
7316 @item bit manipulation instructions
7317 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7318 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7319 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7320 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7321 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7322 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7323 the top page of memory).
7324
7325 @item system control instructions
7326 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7327 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7328 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7329 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7330 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7331 the top page of memory).
7332 @end table
7333
7334 @ifclear GENERIC
7335 @lowersections
7336 @end ifclear
7337 @end ifset
7338
7339 @ifclear GENERIC
7340 @ifset Renesas
7341 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7342 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7343 @node Renesas
7344 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7345
7346 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7347 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7348 options are required for these chips.
7349 @end ifset
7350 @end ifclear
7351
7352 @ifset ARM
7353 @ifclear GENERIC
7354 @raisesections
7355 @end ifclear
7356
7357 @ifset M68HC11
7358 @ifclear GENERIC
7359 @raisesections
7360 @end ifclear
7361
7362 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7363 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7364
7365 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7366
7367 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7368
7369 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7370 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7371
7372 @table @emph
7373 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7374 @item relaxing address modes
7375 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7376 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7377 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7378 respectively.
7379
7380 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7381 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7382 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7383
7384 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7385 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7386 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7387 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7388 @code{bset} instructions.
7389
7390 @end table
7391
7392 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7393
7394 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7395 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7396 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7397 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7398 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7399 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7400 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7401 point to the function trampoline.
7402
7403 @ifclear GENERIC
7404 @lowersections
7405 @end ifclear
7406 @end ifset
7407
7408 @node ARM
7409 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7410
7411 @cindex ARM interworking support
7412 @kindex --support-old-code
7413 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7414 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7415 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7416 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7417 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7418 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7419 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7420 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7421 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7422 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7423
7424 @cindex thumb entry point
7425 @cindex entry point, thumb
7426 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7427 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7428 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7429 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7430 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7431 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7432
7433 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7434 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7435 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7436 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7437 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7438 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7439
7440 @cindex BE8
7441 @kindex --be8
7442 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7443 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7444 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7445 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7446 little-endian code.
7447
7448 @cindex TARGET1
7449 @kindex --target1-rel
7450 @kindex --target1-abs
7451 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7452 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7453 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7454 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7455
7456 @cindex TARGET2
7457 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7458 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7459 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7460 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7461 @table @samp
7462 @item rel
7463 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7464 @item abs
7465 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7466 @item got-rel
7467 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7468 @end table
7469
7470 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7471 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7472 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7473 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7474 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7475 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7476
7477 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7478 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7479 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7480
7481 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7482 relocations are ignored.
7483
7484 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7485 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7486 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7487 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7488
7489 @smallexample
7490 TST rM, #1
7491 MOVEQ PC, rM
7492 BX Rn
7493 @end smallexample
7494
7495 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7496 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7497 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7498
7499 @cindex USE_BLX
7500 @kindex --use-blx
7501 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7502 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7503 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7504 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7505 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7506
7507 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7508 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7509 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7510 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7511 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7512 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7513 the support code can read the intended values.
7514
7515 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7516 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7517 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7518 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7519 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7520 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7521
7522 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7523 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7524 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7525 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7526 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7527 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7528
7529 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7530 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7531 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7532 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7533 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7534 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7535 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7536
7537 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7538 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7539 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7540 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7541 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7542 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7543 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7544
7545 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7546 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7547 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7548
7549 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7550 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7551
7552 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7553 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7554 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7555 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7556 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7557 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7558 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7559 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7560
7561 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7562 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7563
7564 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7565 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7566 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7567 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7568 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7569
7570 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7571 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7572 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7573 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7574 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7575 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7576
7577 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7578 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7579
7580 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7581 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7582 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7583 occurs.
7584
7585 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7586 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7587 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7588 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7589 occurs.
7590
7591 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7592 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7593 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7594 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7595 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7596 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7597 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7598 not be diagnosed.
7599
7600 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7601 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7602 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7603 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7604 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7605 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7606 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7607
7608 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7609 @kindex --pic-veneer
7610 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7611 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7612 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7613 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7614
7615 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7616 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7617 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7618 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7619 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7620 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7621 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7622 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7623 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7624 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7625 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7626 where they should be placed.
7627
7628 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7629 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7630 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7631 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7632 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7633 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7634 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7635 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7636 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7637 from the input sections.
7638
7639 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7640 @samp{N = +1}.
7641
7642 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7643 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7644 otherwise.
7645
7646 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7647 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7648 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7649 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7650
7651 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7652
7653 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7654 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7655 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7656 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7657
7658 Please contact ARM for further details.
7659
7660 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7661 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7662 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7663 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7664
7665 @kindex --long-plt
7666 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7667 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7668 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7669 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7670
7671 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7672 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7673 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7674 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7675
7676 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7677 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7678 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7679 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7680 veneers in memory.
7681
7682 @kindex --cmse-implib
7683 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7684 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7685 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7686 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7687 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7688
7689 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7690 @cindex Input import library
7691 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7692 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7693 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7694 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7695 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7696 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7697 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7698 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7699 specified.
7700
7701 @ifclear GENERIC
7702 @lowersections
7703 @end ifclear
7704 @end ifset
7705
7706 @ifset HPPA
7707 @ifclear GENERIC
7708 @raisesections
7709 @end ifclear
7710
7711 @node HPPA ELF32
7712 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7713 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7714 @kindex --multi-subspace
7715 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7716 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7717 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7718 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7719 multiple sub-spaces.
7720
7721 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7722 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7723 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7724 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7725 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7726 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7727 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7728 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7729 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7730 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7731 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7732 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7733 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7734 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7735 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7736 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7737
7738 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7739 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7740 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7741 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7742
7743 @ifclear GENERIC
7744 @lowersections
7745 @end ifclear
7746 @end ifset
7747
7748 @ifset M68K
7749 @ifclear GENERIC
7750 @raisesections
7751 @end ifclear
7752
7753 @node M68K
7754 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7755
7756 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7757 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7758 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7759 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7760 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7761 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7762 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7763 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7764 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7765 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7766 support such GOTs.
7767 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7768 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7769 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7770 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7771
7772 @ifclear GENERIC
7773 @lowersections
7774 @end ifclear
7775 @end ifset
7776
7777 @ifset MIPS
7778 @ifclear GENERIC
7779 @raisesections
7780 @end ifclear
7781
7782 @node MIPS
7783 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7784
7785 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7786 @kindex --insn32
7787 @kindex --no-insn32
7788 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7789 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7790 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7791 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7792 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7793 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7794
7795 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7796 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7797 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7798 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7799 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7800 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7801 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7802 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7803 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7804 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7805 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7806 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7807
7808 @ifclear GENERIC
7809 @lowersections
7810 @end ifclear
7811 @end ifset
7812
7813 @ifset MMIX
7814 @ifclear GENERIC
7815 @raisesections
7816 @end ifclear
7817
7818 @node MMIX
7819 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7820 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7821 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7822 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7823 can translate between the two formats.
7824
7825 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7826 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7827 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7828 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7829 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7830 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7831 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7832 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7833
7834 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7835 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7836 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7837 of a section.
7838
7839 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7840 are left out from an mmo file.
7841
7842 @ifclear GENERIC
7843 @lowersections
7844 @end ifclear
7845 @end ifset
7846
7847 @ifset MSP430
7848 @ifclear GENERIC
7849 @raisesections
7850 @end ifclear
7851
7852 @node MSP430
7853 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7854 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7855 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7856 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7857
7858 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7859 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7860
7861 @table @code
7862 @item @samp{.vectors}
7863 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7864
7865 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7866 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7867 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7868
7869 @item @samp{.infomem}
7870 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7871 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7872
7873 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7874 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7875 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7876
7877 @item @samp{.noinit}
7878 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7879
7880 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7881 @end table
7882
7883 @table @option
7884 @cindex MSP430 Options
7885 @kindex --code-region
7886 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7887 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7888 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7889 using this option.
7890
7891 @kindex --data-region
7892 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7893 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7894 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7895 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7896
7897 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7898 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7899 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7900 and @code{--data-region} options.
7901 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7902 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7903 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7904 @end table
7905
7906 @ifclear GENERIC
7907 @lowersections
7908 @end ifclear
7909 @end ifset
7910
7911 @ifset NDS32
7912 @ifclear GENERIC
7913 @raisesections
7914 @end ifclear
7915
7916 @node NDS32
7917 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7918 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7919 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7920 relaxes objects according to these options.
7921
7922 @table @code
7923 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7924 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7925
7926 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7927 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7928
7929 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7930 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7931
7932 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7933 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7934
7935 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7936 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7937
7938 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7939 Update the existing EX9 table.
7940
7941 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7942 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7943
7944 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7945 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7946
7947 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7948 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7949
7950 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7951 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7952 @end table
7953
7954 @ifclear GENERIC
7955 @lowersections
7956 @end ifclear
7957 @end ifset
7958
7959 @ifset NIOSII
7960 @ifclear GENERIC
7961 @raisesections
7962 @end ifclear
7963
7964 @node Nios II
7965 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7966 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7967 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7968
7969 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7970 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7971 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7972 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7973 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7974 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7975 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7976 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7977 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7978 larger than 256MB.
7979
7980 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7981 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7982 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7983 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7984 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7985 register as a temporary.
7986
7987 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7988 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7989 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7990
7991 @ifclear GENERIC
7992 @lowersections
7993 @end ifclear
7994 @end ifset
7995
7996 @ifset POWERPC
7997 @ifclear GENERIC
7998 @raisesections
7999 @end ifclear
8000
8001 @node PowerPC ELF32
8002 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8003 @cindex PowerPC long branches
8004 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
8005 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8006 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8007 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8008 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8009 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8010 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8011 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8012 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8013 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8014 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8015
8016 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8017 @table @option
8018 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8019 @kindex --bss-plt
8020 @item --bss-plt
8021 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8022 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8023 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8024 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8025 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8026 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8027 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8028 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8029
8030 @kindex --secure-plt
8031 @item --secure-plt
8032 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8033 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8034 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8035 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8036 style BSS PLT.
8037
8038 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8039 @kindex --sdata-got
8040 @item --sdata-got
8041 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8042 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8043 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8044 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8045 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8046 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8047 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8048 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8049 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8050 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8051 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8052 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8053
8054 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8055 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8056 @item --emit-stub-syms
8057 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8058 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8059
8060 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8061 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8062 @item --no-tls-optimize
8063 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8064 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8065 disable the optimization.
8066 @end table
8067
8068 @ifclear GENERIC
8069 @lowersections
8070 @end ifclear
8071 @end ifset
8072
8073 @ifset POWERPC64
8074 @ifclear GENERIC
8075 @raisesections
8076 @end ifclear
8077
8078 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8079 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8080
8081 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8082 @table @option
8083 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8084 @kindex --stub-group-size
8085 @item --stub-group-size
8086 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8087 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8088 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8089 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8090 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8091 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8092 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8093 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8094 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8095 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8096 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8097 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8098 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8099 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8100
8101 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8102 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8103 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8104 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8105
8106 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8107 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8108 @item --emit-stub-syms
8109 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8110 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8111
8112 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8113 @kindex --dotsyms
8114 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8115 @item --dotsyms
8116 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8117 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8118 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8119 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8120 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8121 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8122 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8123 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8124 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8125 feature.
8126
8127 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8128 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8129 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8130 @item --save-restore-funcs
8131 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8132 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8133 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8134 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8135 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8136 link.
8137
8138 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8139 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8140 @item --no-tls-optimize
8141 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8142 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8143 disable the optimization.
8144
8145 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8146 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8147 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8148 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8149 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8150 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8151 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8152 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8153 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8154 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8155 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8156 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8157 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8158 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8159 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8160 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8161 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8162 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8163 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8164 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8165 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8166 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8167 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8168 register saves.
8169
8170 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8171 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8172 @item --no-opd-optimize
8173 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8174 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8175 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8176 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8177
8178 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8179 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8180 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8181 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8182 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8183 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8184 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8185
8186 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8187 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8188 @item --no-toc-optimize
8189 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8190 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8191 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8192 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8193 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8194 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8195 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8196 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8197 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8198 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8199 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8200 optimization.
8201
8202 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8203 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8204 @item --no-inline-optimize
8205 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8206 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8207 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8208 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8209 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8210 disables that optimization.
8211
8212 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8213 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8214 @item --no-multi-toc
8215 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8216 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8217 where TOC
8218 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8219 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8220 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8221 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8222 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8223 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8224 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8225 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8226
8227 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8228 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8229 @item --no-toc-sort
8230 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8231 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8232 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8233 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8234 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8235 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8236 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8237 off this feature.
8238
8239 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8240 @kindex --plt-align
8241 @kindex --no-plt-align
8242 @item --plt-align
8243 @itemx --no-plt-align
8244 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8245 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8246 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8247 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8248 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8249 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8250 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8251
8252 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8253 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8254 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8255 @item --plt-static-chain
8256 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8257 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8258 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8259 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8260
8261 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8262 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8263 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8264 @item --plt-thread-safe
8265 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8266 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8267 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8268 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8269 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8270 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8271 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8272 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8273 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8274 default behaviour.
8275
8276 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8277 @kindex --plt-localentry
8278 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8279 @item --plt-localentry
8280 @itemx --no-localentry
8281 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8282 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8283 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8284 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8285 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8286 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8287 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8288 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8289 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8290 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8291 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8292 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8293
8294 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8295 @kindex --power10-stubs
8296 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8297 @item --power10-stubs
8298 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8299 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8300 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8301 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8302 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8303 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8304 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8305 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8306 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8307 auto mode.
8308 @end table
8309
8310 @ifclear GENERIC
8311 @lowersections
8312 @end ifclear
8313 @end ifset
8314
8315 @ifset S/390
8316 @ifclear GENERIC
8317 @raisesections
8318 @end ifclear
8319
8320 @node S/390 ELF
8321 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8322
8323 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8324 @table @option
8325
8326 @cindex S/390
8327 @kindex --s390-pgste
8328 @item --s390-pgste
8329 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8330 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8331 binaries marked that way.
8332 @end table
8333
8334 @ifclear GENERIC
8335 @lowersections
8336 @end ifclear
8337 @end ifset
8338
8339 @ifset SPU
8340 @ifclear GENERIC
8341 @raisesections
8342 @end ifclear
8343
8344 @node SPU ELF
8345 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8346
8347 @cindex SPU ELF options
8348 @table @option
8349
8350 @cindex SPU plugins
8351 @kindex --plugin
8352 @item --plugin
8353 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8354
8355 @cindex SPU overlays
8356 @kindex --no-overlays
8357 @item --no-overlays
8358 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8359 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8360 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8361 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8362
8363 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8364 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8365 @item --emit-stub-syms
8366 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8367 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8368
8369 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8370 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8371 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8372 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8373 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8374 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8375
8376 @cindex SPU local store size
8377 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8378 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8379 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8380 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8381 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8382
8383 @cindex SPU
8384 @kindex --stack-analysis
8385 @item --stack-analysis
8386 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8387 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8388 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8389 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8390 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8391 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8392 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8393 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8394 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8395 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8396 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8397 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8398 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8399 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8400 and calls will be given.
8401
8402 @cindex SPU
8403 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8404 @item --emit-stack-syms
8405 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8406 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8407 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8408 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8409 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8410 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8411 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8412 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8413 @end table
8414
8415 @ifclear GENERIC
8416 @lowersections
8417 @end ifclear
8418 @end ifset
8419
8420 @ifset TICOFF
8421 @ifclear GENERIC
8422 @raisesections
8423 @end ifclear
8424
8425 @node TI COFF
8426 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8427 @cindex TI COFF versions
8428 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8429 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8430 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8431 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8432 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8433 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8434
8435 @ifclear GENERIC
8436 @lowersections
8437 @end ifclear
8438 @end ifset
8439
8440 @ifset WIN32
8441 @ifclear GENERIC
8442 @raisesections
8443 @end ifclear
8444
8445 @node WIN32
8446 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8447
8448 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8449 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8450 command-line options mentioned here.
8451
8452 @table @emph
8453 @cindex import libraries
8454 @item import libraries
8455 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8456 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8457 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8458 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8459 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8460 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8461
8462 @item exporting DLL symbols
8463 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8464 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8465
8466 @table @emph
8467 @item using auto-export functionality
8468 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8469 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8470 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8471
8472 @itemize
8473 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8474 @item --exclude-symbols
8475 @item --exclude-libs
8476 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8477 @item --version-script
8478 @end itemize
8479
8480 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8481 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8482 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8483 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8484 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8485 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8486 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8487 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8488
8489 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8490 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8491 if either of the following are true:
8492
8493 @itemize
8494 @item A DEF file is used.
8495 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8496 @end itemize
8497
8498 @item using a DEF file
8499 @cindex using a DEF file
8500 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8501 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8502 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8503 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8504 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8505
8506 @example
8507 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8508 @end example
8509
8510 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8511 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8512
8513 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8514
8515 @example
8516 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8517
8518 EXPORTS
8519 foo
8520 bar
8521 _bar = bar
8522 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8523 var1 DATA
8524 doo = foo == foo2
8525 eoo DATA == var1
8526 @end example
8527
8528 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8529 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8530 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8531 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8532 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8533 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8534 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8535 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8536 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8537
8538 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8539 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8540 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8541
8542 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8543 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8544 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8545 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8546
8547 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8548 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8549 non-default base address for the image.
8550
8551 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8552 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8553 filename specified on the command line.
8554
8555 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8556
8557 @example
8558 EXPORTS
8559 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8560 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8561 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8562 @end example
8563
8564 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8565 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8566 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8567 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8568 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8569 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8570 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8571
8572 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8573
8574 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8575 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8576 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8577 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8578 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8579
8580 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8581 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8582 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8583 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8584
8585 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8586 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8587 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8588 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8589 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8590 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8591 application will behave unexpectedly.
8592
8593 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8594 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8595 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8596 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8597 the DLL without an import library.
8598
8599 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8600 other DEF file statements
8601
8602 @cindex creating a DEF file
8603 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8604 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8605
8606 @item Using decorations
8607 @cindex Using decorations
8608 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8609 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8610 declared as:
8611
8612 @example
8613 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8614 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8615 @end example
8616
8617 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8618 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8619 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8620 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8621
8622 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8623 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8624 instead:
8625
8626 @example
8627 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8628 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8629 @end example
8630
8631 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8632 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8633 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8634 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8635 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8636 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8637 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8638 information.
8639 @end table
8640
8641 @cindex automatic data imports
8642 @item automatic data imports
8643 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8644 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8645 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8646 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8647 code to these platforms, especially for large
8648 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8649 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8650 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8651 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8652 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8653 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8654 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8655 trigger the feature's use.
8656
8657 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8658 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8659
8660 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8661 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8662
8663 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8664 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8665 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8666 below.
8667
8668 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8669 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8670 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8671 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8672 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8673 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8674 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8675 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8676 references.
8677
8678 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8679 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8680 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8681 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8682 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8683 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8684 run without error on an older system.
8685
8686 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8687 enabled as needed.
8688
8689 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8690 @item direct linking to a dll
8691 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8692 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8693 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8694 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8695 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8696 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8697 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8698 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8699 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8700 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8701
8702 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8703 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8704 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8705 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8706 select the dll instead of an import library.
8707
8708
8709 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8710 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8711
8712 @example
8713 libxxx.dll.a
8714 xxx.dll.a
8715 libxxx.a
8716 xxx.lib
8717 libxxx.lib
8718 cygxxx.dll (*)
8719 libxxx.dll
8720 xxx.dll
8721 @end example
8722
8723 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8724
8725 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8726 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8727 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8728 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8729 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8730
8731 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8732 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8733 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8734 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8735 could coexist on the same machine.
8736
8737 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8738 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8739 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8740
8741 @example
8742 bin/
8743 cygxxx.dll
8744 lib/
8745 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8746 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8747 @end example
8748
8749 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8750 done two ways:
8751
8752 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8753 @example
8754 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8755 @end example
8756
8757 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8758 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8759 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8760 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8761
8762 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8763 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8764 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8765 making the app/dll.
8766
8767 @example
8768 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8769 @end example
8770
8771 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8772
8773 @example
8774 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8775 @end example
8776
8777 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8778 perfectly legal
8779
8780 @example
8781 bin/
8782 cygxxx-5.dll
8783 lib/
8784 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8785 @end example
8786
8787 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8788 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8789 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8790
8791 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8792 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8793
8794 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8795 work with auto-imported data.
8796
8797 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8798 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8799 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8800 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8801 possible to do this without an import lib.
8802
8803 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8804 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8805 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8806 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8807
8808 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8809 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8810 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8811 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8812 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8813 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8814 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8815
8816 @item symbol aliasing
8817 @table @emph
8818 @item adding additional names
8819 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8820 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8821 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8822 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8823 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8824
8825 @example
8826 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8827
8828 EXPORTS
8829 foo
8830 _foo = foo
8831 @end example
8832
8833 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8834
8835 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8836 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8837
8838 @example
8839 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8840 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8841 @end example
8842
8843 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8844 symbols.
8845
8846 @item renaming symbols
8847 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8848 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8849 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8850 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8851 created). In the following example:
8852
8853 @example
8854 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8855
8856 EXPORTS
8857 _foo = foo
8858 @end example
8859
8860 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8861 @samp{_foo}.
8862 @end table
8863
8864 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8865 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8866 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8867 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8868 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8869 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8870 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8871 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8872 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8873 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8874 which is probably not what you wanted.
8875
8876 @cindex weak externals
8877 @item weak externals
8878 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8879 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8880 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8881 are three variants of weak externals:
8882 @itemize
8883 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8884 called lazy externals.
8885 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8886 This form is not presently implemented.
8887 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8888 implemented.
8889 @end itemize
8890 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8891 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8892 uses a default value.
8893
8894 @cindex aligned common symbols
8895 @item aligned common symbols
8896 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8897 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8898 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8899 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8900 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8901 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8902 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8903 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8904
8905 @end table
8906
8907 @ifclear GENERIC
8908 @lowersections
8909 @end ifclear
8910 @end ifset
8911
8912 @ifset XTENSA
8913 @ifclear GENERIC
8914 @raisesections
8915 @end ifclear
8916
8917 @node Xtensa
8918 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8919
8920 @cindex Xtensa processors
8921 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8922 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8923 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8924 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8925 example, with the command:
8926
8927 @smallexample
8928 SECTIONS
8929 @{
8930 .text : @{
8931 *(.literal .text)
8932 @}
8933 @}
8934 @end smallexample
8935
8936 @noindent
8937 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8938 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8939 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8940 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8941 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8942 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8943 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8944
8945 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8946 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8947 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8948 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8949 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8950 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8951 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8952 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8953 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8954 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8955 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8956 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8957
8958 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8959 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8960 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8961 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8962 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8963 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8964 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8965 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8966 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8967 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8968 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8969 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8970 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8971 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8972
8973 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8974 control the linker:
8975
8976 @cindex Xtensa options
8977 @table @option
8978 @item --size-opt
8979 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8980 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8981 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8982 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8983 preserve the correctness of the code.
8984
8985 @item --abi-windowed
8986 @itemx --abi-call0
8987 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8988 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8989 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8990 conventions.
8991 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8992 of the first input object.
8993 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8994 or the chosen output object ABI.
8995 @end table
8996
8997 @ifclear GENERIC
8998 @lowersections
8999 @end ifclear
9000 @end ifset
9001
9002 @ifclear SingleFormat
9003 @node BFD
9004 @chapter BFD
9005
9006 @cindex back end
9007 @cindex object file management
9008 @cindex object formats available
9009 @kindex objdump -i
9010 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9011 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9012 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9013 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9014 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9015 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9016 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9017 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9018 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9019
9020 @cindex BFD requirements
9021 @cindex requirements for BFD
9022 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9023 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9024 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9025 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9026 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9027 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9028 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9029
9030 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9031 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9032 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9033 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9034
9035 @menu
9036 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9037 @end menu
9038
9039 @node BFD outline
9040 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9041 @cindex opening object files
9042 @include bfdsumm.texi
9043 @end ifclear
9044
9045 @node Reporting Bugs
9046 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9047 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9048 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9049
9050 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9051
9052 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9053 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9054 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9055 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9056 @command{ld}.
9057
9058 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9059 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9060
9061 @menu
9062 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9063 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9064 @end menu
9065
9066 @node Bug Criteria
9067 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9068 @cindex bug criteria
9069
9070 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9071
9072 @itemize @bullet
9073 @cindex fatal signal
9074 @cindex linker crash
9075 @cindex crash of linker
9076 @item
9077 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9078 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9079
9080 @cindex error on valid input
9081 @item
9082 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9083
9084 @cindex invalid input
9085 @item
9086 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9087 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9088 object files are correct.
9089
9090 @item
9091 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9092 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9093 @end itemize
9094
9095 @node Bug Reporting
9096 @section How to Report Bugs
9097 @cindex bug reports
9098 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9099
9100 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9101 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9102 recommend you contact that organization first.
9103
9104 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9105 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9106 distribution.
9107
9108 @ifset BUGURL
9109 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9110 @value{BUGURL}.
9111 @end ifset
9112
9113 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9114 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9115 fact or leave it out, state it!
9116
9117 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9118 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9119 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9120 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9121 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9122 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9123 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9124 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9125 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9126 and the most helpful.
9127
9128 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9129 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9130 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9131
9132 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9133 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9134 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9135 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9136
9137 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9138
9139 @itemize @bullet
9140 @item
9141 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9142 the @samp{--version} argument.
9143
9144 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9145 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9146
9147 @item
9148 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9149 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9150
9151 @item
9152 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9153 version number.
9154
9155 @item
9156 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9157 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9158
9159 @item
9160 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9161 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9162 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9163 sufficient.
9164
9165 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9166 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9167
9168 @item
9169 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9170 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9171 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9172 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9173 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9174 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9175 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9176 attachments are best.
9177
9178 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9179 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9180 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9181 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9182 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9183
9184 @item
9185 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9186 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9187
9188 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9189 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9190 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9191 a chance to make a mistake.
9192
9193 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9194 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9195 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9196 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9197 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9198 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9199 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9200 any conclusion from our observations.
9201
9202 @item
9203 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9204 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9205 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9206 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9207 context, not by line number.
9208
9209 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9210 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9211 @end itemize
9212
9213 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9214
9215 @itemize @bullet
9216 @item
9217 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9218
9219 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9220 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9221 changes will not affect it.
9222
9223 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9224 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9225 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9226 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9227
9228 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9229 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9230 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9231 less time, and so on.
9232
9233 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9234 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9235
9236 @item
9237 A patch for the bug.
9238
9239 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9240 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9241 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9242 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9243
9244 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9245 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9246 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9247 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9248 fixed.
9249
9250 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9251 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9252 help us to understand.
9253
9254 @item
9255 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9256
9257 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9258 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9259 @end itemize
9260
9261 @node MRI
9262 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9263 @cindex MRI compatibility
9264 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9265 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9266 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9267 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9268 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9269 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9270 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9271
9272 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9273 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9274 features to make use of them.
9275
9276 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9277 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9278
9279 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9280 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9281 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9282 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9283 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9284
9285 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9286
9287 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9288 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9289 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9290
9291 @table @code
9292 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9293 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9294 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9295 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9296 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9297 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9298 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9299 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9300 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9301 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9302 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9303
9304 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9305 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9306 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9307 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9308
9309 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9310
9311 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9312 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9313 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9314 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9315
9316 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9317 @item BASE @var{expression}
9318 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9319 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9320
9321 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9322 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9323 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9324 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9325
9326 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9327 @item END
9328 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9329
9330 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9331 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9332 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9333 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9334
9335 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9336 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9337 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9338 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9339
9340 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9341 same line, with no change in its effect.
9342
9343 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9344 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9345 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9346 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9347 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9348 command line.
9349
9350 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9351 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9352 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9353 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9354 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9355
9356 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9357 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9358 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9359 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9360 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9361 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9362 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9363 file, in the order specified.
9364
9365 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9366 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9367 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9368 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9369 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9370 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9371
9372 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9373 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9374 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9375 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9376 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9377 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9378 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9379 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9380 @end table
9381
9382 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9383 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9384 @include fdl.texi
9385
9386 @node LD Index
9387 @unnumbered LD Index
9388
9389 @printindex cp
9390
9391 @tex
9392 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9393 % meantime:
9394 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9395 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9396 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9397 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9398 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9399 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9400 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9401 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9402 \page\colophon
9403 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9404 @end tex
9405
9406 @bye